You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

25327 lines
674KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @subsection Commands
  356. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  357. @section acontrast
  358. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  359. The filter accepts the following options:
  360. @table @option
  361. @item contrast
  362. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  363. @end table
  364. @section acopy
  365. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  366. testing purposes.
  367. @section acrossfade
  368. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  369. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  370. The filter accepts the following options:
  371. @table @option
  372. @item nb_samples, ns
  373. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  374. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  375. silent. Default is 44100.
  376. @item duration, d
  377. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  378. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  379. for the accepted syntax.
  380. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  381. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  382. @item overlap, o
  383. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  384. @item curve1
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  386. @item curve2
  387. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  388. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  389. @end table
  390. @subsection Examples
  391. @itemize
  392. @item
  393. Cross fade from one input to another:
  394. @example
  395. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  396. @end example
  397. @item
  398. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  399. @example
  400. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  401. @end example
  402. @end itemize
  403. @section acrossover
  404. Split audio stream into several bands.
  405. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  406. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  407. The filter accepts the following options:
  408. @table @option
  409. @item split
  410. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  411. @item order
  412. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  413. Default is @var{4th}.
  414. @end table
  415. @section acrusher
  416. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  417. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  418. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  419. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  420. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  421. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  422. bit depths.
  423. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  424. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  425. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  426. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  427. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  428. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  429. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  430. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  431. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  432. The filter accepts the following options:
  433. @table @option
  434. @item level_in
  435. Set level in.
  436. @item level_out
  437. Set level out.
  438. @item bits
  439. Set bit reduction.
  440. @item mix
  441. Set mixing amount.
  442. @item mode
  443. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  444. @item dc
  445. Set DC.
  446. @item aa
  447. Set anti-aliasing.
  448. @item samples
  449. Set sample reduction.
  450. @item lfo
  451. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  452. @item lforange
  453. Set LFO range.
  454. @item lforate
  455. Set LFO rate.
  456. @end table
  457. @section acue
  458. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  459. filter.
  460. @section adeclick
  461. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  462. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  463. autoregressive modelling.
  464. @table @option
  465. @item w
  466. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  467. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  468. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  469. @item o
  470. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  471. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  472. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  473. whole process much slower.
  474. @item a
  475. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  476. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  477. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  478. @item t
  479. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  480. Default value is @code{2}.
  481. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  482. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  483. @item b
  484. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  485. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  486. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  487. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  488. @item m
  489. Set overlap method.
  490. It accepts the following values:
  491. @table @option
  492. @item a
  493. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  494. changed with this method.
  495. @item s
  496. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  497. @end table
  498. Default value is @code{a}.
  499. @end table
  500. @section adeclip
  501. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  502. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  503. autoregressive modelling.
  504. @table @option
  505. @item w
  506. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  507. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  508. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  509. @item o
  510. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  511. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  512. @item a
  513. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  514. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  515. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  516. @item t
  517. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  518. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  519. @item n
  520. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  521. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  522. @item m
  523. Set overlap method.
  524. It accepts the following values:
  525. @table @option
  526. @item a
  527. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  528. with this method.
  529. @item s
  530. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  531. @end table
  532. Default value is @code{a}.
  533. @end table
  534. @section adelay
  535. Delay one or more audio channels.
  536. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  537. The filter accepts the following option:
  538. @table @option
  539. @item delays
  540. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  541. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  542. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  543. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  544. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  545. @item all
  546. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  547. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  548. @end table
  549. @subsection Examples
  550. @itemize
  551. @item
  552. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  553. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  554. @example
  555. adelay=1500|0|500
  556. @end example
  557. @item
  558. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  559. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  560. @example
  561. adelay=0|500S|700S
  562. @end example
  563. @item
  564. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  565. @example
  566. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  567. @end example
  568. @end itemize
  569. @section aderivative, aintegral
  570. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  571. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  572. @section aecho
  573. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  574. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  575. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  576. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  577. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  578. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  579. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  580. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  581. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  582. @table @option
  583. @item in_gain
  584. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  585. @item out_gain
  586. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  587. @item delays
  588. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  589. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  590. Default is @code{1000}.
  591. @item decays
  592. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  593. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  594. Default is @code{0.5}.
  595. @end table
  596. @subsection Examples
  597. @itemize
  598. @item
  599. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  600. @example
  601. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  602. @end example
  603. @item
  604. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  605. @example
  606. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  607. @end example
  608. @item
  609. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  610. @example
  611. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  612. @end example
  613. @item
  614. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  615. @example
  616. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  617. @end example
  618. @end itemize
  619. @section aemphasis
  620. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  621. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  622. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  623. this recording medium.
  624. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  625. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  626. The filter accepts the following options:
  627. @table @option
  628. @item level_in
  629. Set input gain.
  630. @item level_out
  631. Set output gain.
  632. @item mode
  633. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  634. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  635. @item type
  636. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  637. @table @option
  638. @item col
  639. select Columbia.
  640. @item emi
  641. select EMI.
  642. @item bsi
  643. select BSI (78RPM).
  644. @item riaa
  645. select RIAA.
  646. @item cd
  647. select Compact Disc (CD).
  648. @item 50fm
  649. select 50µs (FM).
  650. @item 75fm
  651. select 75µs (FM).
  652. @item 50kf
  653. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  654. @item 75kf
  655. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  656. @end table
  657. @end table
  658. @section aeval
  659. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  660. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  661. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  662. It accepts the following parameters:
  663. @table @option
  664. @item exprs
  665. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  666. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  667. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  668. output channels.
  669. @item channel_layout, c
  670. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  671. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  672. use by default the same input channel layout.
  673. @end table
  674. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  675. @table @option
  676. @item ch
  677. channel number of the current expression
  678. @item n
  679. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  680. @item s
  681. sample rate
  682. @item t
  683. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  684. @item nb_in_channels
  685. @item nb_out_channels
  686. input and output number of channels
  687. @item val(CH)
  688. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  689. @end table
  690. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  691. dedicated filter.
  692. @subsection Examples
  693. @itemize
  694. @item
  695. Half volume:
  696. @example
  697. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  698. @end example
  699. @item
  700. Invert phase of the second channel:
  701. @example
  702. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  703. @end example
  704. @end itemize
  705. @anchor{afade}
  706. @section afade
  707. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  708. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  709. @table @option
  710. @item type, t
  711. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  712. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  713. @item start_sample, ss
  714. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  715. effect. Default is 0.
  716. @item nb_samples, ns
  717. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  718. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  719. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  720. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  721. @item start_time, st
  722. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  723. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  724. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  725. for the accepted syntax.
  726. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  727. @item duration, d
  728. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  729. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  730. for the accepted syntax.
  731. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  732. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  733. the output audio will be silence.
  734. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  735. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  736. @item curve
  737. Set curve for fade transition.
  738. It accepts the following values:
  739. @table @option
  740. @item tri
  741. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  742. @item qsin
  743. select quarter of sine wave
  744. @item hsin
  745. select half of sine wave
  746. @item esin
  747. select exponential sine wave
  748. @item log
  749. select logarithmic
  750. @item ipar
  751. select inverted parabola
  752. @item qua
  753. select quadratic
  754. @item cub
  755. select cubic
  756. @item squ
  757. select square root
  758. @item cbr
  759. select cubic root
  760. @item par
  761. select parabola
  762. @item exp
  763. select exponential
  764. @item iqsin
  765. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  766. @item ihsin
  767. select inverted half of sine wave
  768. @item dese
  769. select double-exponential seat
  770. @item desi
  771. select double-exponential sigmoid
  772. @item losi
  773. select logistic sigmoid
  774. @item nofade
  775. no fade applied
  776. @end table
  777. @end table
  778. @subsection Examples
  779. @itemize
  780. @item
  781. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  782. @example
  783. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  784. @end example
  785. @item
  786. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  787. @example
  788. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  789. @end example
  790. @end itemize
  791. @section afftdn
  792. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  793. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  794. @table @option
  795. @item nr
  796. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  797. Default value is 12 dB.
  798. @item nf
  799. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  800. Default value is -50 dB.
  801. @item nt
  802. Set the noise type.
  803. It accepts the following values:
  804. @table @option
  805. @item w
  806. Select white noise.
  807. @item v
  808. Select vinyl noise.
  809. @item s
  810. Select shellac noise.
  811. @item c
  812. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  813. Default value is white noise.
  814. @end table
  815. @item bn
  816. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  817. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  818. @item rf
  819. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  820. Default value is -38 dB.
  821. @item tn
  822. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  823. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  824. @item tr
  825. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  826. @item om
  827. Set the output mode.
  828. It accepts the following values:
  829. @table @option
  830. @item i
  831. Pass input unchanged.
  832. @item o
  833. Pass noise filtered out.
  834. @item n
  835. Pass only noise.
  836. Default value is @var{o}.
  837. @end table
  838. @end table
  839. @subsection Commands
  840. This filter supports the following commands:
  841. @table @option
  842. @item sample_noise, sn
  843. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  844. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  845. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  846. automatically applied in filtering.
  847. @item noise_reduction, nr
  848. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  849. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  850. @item noise_floor, nf
  851. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  852. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  853. @item output_mode, om
  854. Change output mode operation.
  855. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  856. @end table
  857. @section afftfilt
  858. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  859. @table @option
  860. @item real
  861. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  862. by '|'. Default is "re".
  863. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  864. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  865. output channels.
  866. @item imag
  867. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  868. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  869. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  870. constants and functions:
  871. @table @option
  872. @item sr
  873. sample rate
  874. @item b
  875. current frequency bin number
  876. @item nb
  877. number of available bins
  878. @item ch
  879. channel number of the current expression
  880. @item chs
  881. number of channels
  882. @item pts
  883. current frame pts
  884. @item re
  885. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item im
  887. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  888. @item real(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @item imag(b, ch)
  891. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  892. @end table
  893. @item win_size
  894. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  895. Default is @code{4096}
  896. @item win_func
  897. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  898. @item overlap
  899. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  900. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  901. @end table
  902. @subsection Examples
  903. @itemize
  904. @item
  905. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  906. @example
  907. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  908. @end example
  909. @item
  910. Apply robotize effect:
  911. @example
  912. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  913. @end example
  914. @item
  915. Apply whisper effect:
  916. @example
  917. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  918. @end example
  919. @end itemize
  920. @anchor{afir}
  921. @section afir
  922. Apply an arbitrary Finite Impulse Response filter.
  923. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  924. up to 60 seconds long.
  925. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  926. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  927. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  928. This filter uses the streams higher than first one as FIR coefficients.
  929. If the non-first stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  930. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  931. the number of channels in the non-first stream must be same as
  932. the number of channels in the first stream.
  933. It accepts the following parameters:
  934. @table @option
  935. @item dry
  936. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  937. @item wet
  938. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  939. @item length
  940. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  941. @item gtype
  942. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  943. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  944. @table @option
  945. @item none
  946. Do not apply any gain.
  947. @item peak
  948. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  949. @item dc
  950. select DC gain, limited application.
  951. @item gn
  952. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  953. @end table
  954. @item irgain
  955. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  956. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  957. @item irfmt
  958. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  959. Default is @code{input}.
  960. @item maxir
  961. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  962. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  963. @item response
  964. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  965. By default it is disabled.
  966. @item channel
  967. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  968. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item size
  970. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item rate
  972. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  973. @item minp
  974. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  975. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32768}.
  976. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  977. @item maxp
  978. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  979. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  980. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  981. @item nbirs
  982. Set number of input impulse responses streams which will be switchable at runtime.
  983. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32}. Default is @var{1}.
  984. @item ir
  985. Set IR stream which will be used for convolution, starting from @var{0}, should always be
  986. lower than supplied value by @code{nbirs} option. Default is @var{0}.
  987. This option can be changed at runtime via @ref{commands}.
  988. @end table
  989. @subsection Examples
  990. @itemize
  991. @item
  992. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  993. @example
  994. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  995. @end example
  996. @end itemize
  997. @anchor{aformat}
  998. @section aformat
  999. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  1000. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  1001. It accepts the following parameters:
  1002. @table @option
  1003. @item sample_fmts, f
  1004. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  1005. @item sample_rates, r
  1006. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  1007. @item channel_layouts, cl
  1008. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1009. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1010. for the required syntax.
  1011. @end table
  1012. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1013. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1014. @example
  1015. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1016. @end example
  1017. @section agate
  1018. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1019. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1020. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1021. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1022. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1023. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1024. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1025. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1026. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1027. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1028. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1029. @table @option
  1030. @item level_in
  1031. Set input level before filtering.
  1032. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1033. @item mode
  1034. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1035. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1036. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1037. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1038. @item range
  1039. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1040. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1041. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1042. @item threshold
  1043. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1044. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1045. @item ratio
  1046. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1047. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1048. @item attack
  1049. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1050. reduction stops.
  1051. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1052. @item release
  1053. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1054. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1055. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1056. @item makeup
  1057. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1058. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1059. @item knee
  1060. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1061. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1062. @item detection
  1063. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1064. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1065. @item link
  1066. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1067. the reduction.
  1068. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1069. @end table
  1070. @section aiir
  1071. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1072. It accepts the following parameters:
  1073. @table @option
  1074. @item z
  1075. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1076. @item p
  1077. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1078. @item k
  1079. Set channels gains.
  1080. @item dry_gain
  1081. Set input gain.
  1082. @item wet_gain
  1083. Set output gain.
  1084. @item f
  1085. Set coefficients format.
  1086. @table @samp
  1087. @item tf
  1088. transfer function
  1089. @item zp
  1090. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1091. @item pr
  1092. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1093. @item pd
  1094. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1095. @end table
  1096. @item r
  1097. Set kind of processing.
  1098. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1099. @item e
  1100. Set filtering precision.
  1101. @table @samp
  1102. @item dbl
  1103. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1104. @item flt
  1105. single-precision floating-point
  1106. @item i32
  1107. 32-bit integers
  1108. @item i16
  1109. 16-bit integers
  1110. @end table
  1111. @item mix
  1112. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1113. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1114. @item response
  1115. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1116. By default it is disabled.
  1117. @item channel
  1118. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1119. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1120. @item size
  1121. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1122. @end table
  1123. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1124. order.
  1125. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1126. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1127. imaginary unit.
  1128. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1129. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1130. used for all remaining channels.
  1131. @subsection Examples
  1132. @itemize
  1133. @item
  1134. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1135. @example
  1136. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1137. @end example
  1138. @item
  1139. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1140. @example
  1141. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1142. @end example
  1143. @end itemize
  1144. @section alimiter
  1145. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1146. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1147. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1148. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1149. The filter accepts the following options:
  1150. @table @option
  1151. @item level_in
  1152. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1153. @item level_out
  1154. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1155. @item limit
  1156. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1157. @item attack
  1158. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1159. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1160. @item release
  1161. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1162. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1163. @item asc
  1164. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1165. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1166. time.
  1167. @item asc_level
  1168. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1169. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1170. @item level
  1171. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1172. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1173. @end table
  1174. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1175. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1176. @section allpass
  1177. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1178. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1179. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1180. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1181. The filter accepts the following options:
  1182. @table @option
  1183. @item frequency, f
  1184. Set frequency in Hz.
  1185. @item width_type, t
  1186. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item h
  1189. Hz
  1190. @item q
  1191. Q-Factor
  1192. @item o
  1193. octave
  1194. @item s
  1195. slope
  1196. @item k
  1197. kHz
  1198. @end table
  1199. @item width, w
  1200. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1201. @item mix, m
  1202. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1203. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1204. @item channels, c
  1205. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1206. @item normalize, n
  1207. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  1208. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1209. @end table
  1210. @subsection Commands
  1211. This filter supports the following commands:
  1212. @table @option
  1213. @item frequency, f
  1214. Change allpass frequency.
  1215. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1216. @item width_type, t
  1217. Change allpass width_type.
  1218. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1219. @item width, w
  1220. Change allpass width.
  1221. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1222. @item mix, m
  1223. Change allpass mix.
  1224. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1225. @end table
  1226. @section aloop
  1227. Loop audio samples.
  1228. The filter accepts the following options:
  1229. @table @option
  1230. @item loop
  1231. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1232. Default is 0.
  1233. @item size
  1234. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1235. @item start
  1236. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1237. @end table
  1238. @anchor{amerge}
  1239. @section amerge
  1240. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1241. The filter accepts the following options:
  1242. @table @option
  1243. @item inputs
  1244. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1245. @end table
  1246. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1247. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1248. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1249. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1250. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1251. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1252. channels.
  1253. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1254. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1255. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1256. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1257. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1258. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1259. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1260. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1261. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1262. shortest.
  1263. @subsection Examples
  1264. @itemize
  1265. @item
  1266. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1267. @example
  1268. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1269. @end example
  1270. @item
  1271. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1272. @example
  1273. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1274. @end example
  1275. @end itemize
  1276. @section amix
  1277. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1278. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1279. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1280. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1281. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1282. For example
  1283. @example
  1284. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1285. @end example
  1286. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1287. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1288. It accepts the following parameters:
  1289. @table @option
  1290. @item inputs
  1291. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1292. @item duration
  1293. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1294. @table @option
  1295. @item longest
  1296. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1297. @item shortest
  1298. The duration of the shortest input.
  1299. @item first
  1300. The duration of the first input.
  1301. @end table
  1302. @item dropout_transition
  1303. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1304. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1305. @item weights
  1306. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1307. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1308. @end table
  1309. @section amultiply
  1310. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1311. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1312. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1313. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1314. amplitude modulations.
  1315. @section anequalizer
  1316. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1317. It accepts the following parameters:
  1318. @table @option
  1319. @item params
  1320. This option string is in format:
  1321. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1322. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1323. @table @option
  1324. @item chn
  1325. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1326. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1327. @item f
  1328. Set central frequency for band.
  1329. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1330. @item w
  1331. Set band width in hertz.
  1332. @item g
  1333. Set band gain in dB.
  1334. @item t
  1335. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1336. @table @samp
  1337. @item 0
  1338. Butterworth, this is default.
  1339. @item 1
  1340. Chebyshev type 1.
  1341. @item 2
  1342. Chebyshev type 2.
  1343. @end table
  1344. @end table
  1345. @item curves
  1346. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1347. in video stream.
  1348. @item size
  1349. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1350. @item mgain
  1351. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1352. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1353. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1354. when both are activated.
  1355. @item fscale
  1356. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1357. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1358. @item colors
  1359. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1360. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1361. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1362. @end table
  1363. @subsection Examples
  1364. @itemize
  1365. @item
  1366. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1367. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1368. @example
  1369. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1370. @end example
  1371. @end itemize
  1372. @subsection Commands
  1373. This filter supports the following commands:
  1374. @table @option
  1375. @item change
  1376. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1377. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1378. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1379. error is returned.
  1380. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1381. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1382. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1383. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1384. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1385. @end table
  1386. @section anlmdn
  1387. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1388. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1389. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1390. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1391. The filter accepts the following options:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item s
  1394. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1395. @item p
  1396. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1397. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1398. @item r
  1399. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1400. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1401. @item o
  1402. Set the output mode.
  1403. It accepts the following values:
  1404. @table @option
  1405. @item i
  1406. Pass input unchanged.
  1407. @item o
  1408. Pass noise filtered out.
  1409. @item n
  1410. Pass only noise.
  1411. Default value is @var{o}.
  1412. @end table
  1413. @item m
  1414. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1415. @end table
  1416. @subsection Commands
  1417. This filter supports the following commands:
  1418. @table @option
  1419. @item s
  1420. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1421. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1422. @item o
  1423. Change output mode.
  1424. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1425. @end table
  1426. @section anlms
  1427. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1428. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1429. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1430. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1431. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1432. @table @option
  1433. @item order
  1434. Set filter order.
  1435. @item mu
  1436. Set filter mu.
  1437. @item eps
  1438. Set the filter eps.
  1439. @item leakage
  1440. Set the filter leakage.
  1441. @item out_mode
  1442. It accepts the following values:
  1443. @table @option
  1444. @item i
  1445. Pass the 1st input.
  1446. @item d
  1447. Pass the 2nd input.
  1448. @item o
  1449. Pass filtered samples.
  1450. @item n
  1451. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1452. Default value is @var{o}.
  1453. @end table
  1454. @end table
  1455. @subsection Examples
  1456. @itemize
  1457. @item
  1458. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1459. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1460. @example
  1461. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1462. @end example
  1463. @end itemize
  1464. @subsection Commands
  1465. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1466. @section anull
  1467. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1468. @section apad
  1469. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1470. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1471. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1472. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1473. @table @option
  1474. @item packet_size
  1475. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1476. @item pad_len
  1477. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1478. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1479. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1480. @item whole_len
  1481. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1482. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1483. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1484. with @option{pad_len}.
  1485. @item pad_dur
  1486. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1487. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1488. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1489. @item whole_dur
  1490. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1491. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1492. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1493. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1494. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1495. @end table
  1496. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1497. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1498. the input stream indefinitely.
  1499. @subsection Examples
  1500. @itemize
  1501. @item
  1502. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1503. @example
  1504. apad=pad_len=1024
  1505. @end example
  1506. @item
  1507. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1508. the input with silence if required:
  1509. @example
  1510. apad=whole_len=10000
  1511. @end example
  1512. @item
  1513. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1514. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1515. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1516. option:
  1517. @example
  1518. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1519. @end example
  1520. @end itemize
  1521. @section aphaser
  1522. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1523. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1524. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1525. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1526. @table @option
  1527. @item in_gain
  1528. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1529. @item out_gain
  1530. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1531. @item delay
  1532. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1533. @item decay
  1534. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1535. @item speed
  1536. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1537. @item type
  1538. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1539. It accepts the following values:
  1540. @table @samp
  1541. @item triangular, t
  1542. @item sinusoidal, s
  1543. @end table
  1544. @end table
  1545. @section apulsator
  1546. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1547. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1548. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1549. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1550. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1551. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1552. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1553. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1554. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1555. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1556. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1557. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1558. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1559. The filter accepts the following options:
  1560. @table @option
  1561. @item level_in
  1562. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1563. @item level_out
  1564. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1565. @item mode
  1566. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1567. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1568. @item amount
  1569. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1570. @item offset_l
  1571. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1572. @item offset_r
  1573. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1574. @item width
  1575. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1576. @item timing
  1577. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1578. @item bpm
  1579. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1580. is set to bpm.
  1581. @item ms
  1582. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1583. is set to ms.
  1584. @item hz
  1585. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1586. if timing is set to hz.
  1587. @end table
  1588. @anchor{aresample}
  1589. @section aresample
  1590. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1591. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1592. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1593. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1594. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1595. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1596. The filter accepts the syntax
  1597. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1598. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1599. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1600. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1601. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1602. for the complete list of supported options.
  1603. @subsection Examples
  1604. @itemize
  1605. @item
  1606. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1607. @example
  1608. aresample=44100
  1609. @end example
  1610. @item
  1611. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1612. samples per second compensation:
  1613. @example
  1614. aresample=async=1000
  1615. @end example
  1616. @end itemize
  1617. @section areverse
  1618. Reverse an audio clip.
  1619. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1620. is suggested.
  1621. @subsection Examples
  1622. @itemize
  1623. @item
  1624. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1625. @example
  1626. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1627. @end example
  1628. @end itemize
  1629. @section arnndn
  1630. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1631. This filter accepts the following options:
  1632. @table @option
  1633. @item model, m
  1634. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1635. @end table
  1636. @section asetnsamples
  1637. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1638. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1639. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1640. signals its end.
  1641. The filter accepts the following options:
  1642. @table @option
  1643. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1644. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1645. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1646. Default value is 1024.
  1647. @item pad, p
  1648. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1649. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1650. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1651. @end table
  1652. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1653. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1654. @example
  1655. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1656. @end example
  1657. @section asetrate
  1658. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1659. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1660. The filter accepts the following options:
  1661. @table @option
  1662. @item sample_rate, r
  1663. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1664. @end table
  1665. @section ashowinfo
  1666. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1667. The input audio is not modified.
  1668. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1669. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1670. The following values are shown in the output:
  1671. @table @option
  1672. @item n
  1673. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1674. @item pts
  1675. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1676. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1677. @item pts_time
  1678. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1679. @item pos
  1680. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1681. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1682. @item fmt
  1683. The sample format.
  1684. @item chlayout
  1685. The channel layout.
  1686. @item rate
  1687. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1688. @item nb_samples
  1689. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1690. @item checksum
  1691. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1692. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1693. @item plane_checksums
  1694. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1695. @end table
  1696. @section asoftclip
  1697. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1698. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1699. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1700. This filter accepts the following options:
  1701. @table @option
  1702. @item type
  1703. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1704. It accepts the following values:
  1705. @table @option
  1706. @item tanh
  1707. @item atan
  1708. @item cubic
  1709. @item exp
  1710. @item alg
  1711. @item quintic
  1712. @item sin
  1713. @end table
  1714. @item param
  1715. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1716. @end table
  1717. @subsection Commands
  1718. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  1719. @section asr
  1720. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1721. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1722. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1723. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1724. It accepts the following options:
  1725. @table @option
  1726. @item rate
  1727. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1728. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1729. @item hmm
  1730. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1731. @item dict
  1732. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1733. @item lm
  1734. Set language model file.
  1735. @item lmctl
  1736. Set language model set.
  1737. @item lmname
  1738. Set which language model to use.
  1739. @item logfn
  1740. Set output for log messages.
  1741. @end table
  1742. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1743. @anchor{astats}
  1744. @section astats
  1745. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1746. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1747. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1748. It accepts the following option:
  1749. @table @option
  1750. @item length
  1751. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1752. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1753. @item metadata
  1754. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1755. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1756. disabled.
  1757. Available keys for each channel are:
  1758. DC_offset
  1759. Min_level
  1760. Max_level
  1761. Min_difference
  1762. Max_difference
  1763. Mean_difference
  1764. RMS_difference
  1765. Peak_level
  1766. RMS_peak
  1767. RMS_trough
  1768. Crest_factor
  1769. Flat_factor
  1770. Peak_count
  1771. Bit_depth
  1772. Dynamic_range
  1773. Zero_crossings
  1774. Zero_crossings_rate
  1775. Number_of_NaNs
  1776. Number_of_Infs
  1777. Number_of_denormals
  1778. and for Overall:
  1779. DC_offset
  1780. Min_level
  1781. Max_level
  1782. Min_difference
  1783. Max_difference
  1784. Mean_difference
  1785. RMS_difference
  1786. Peak_level
  1787. RMS_level
  1788. RMS_peak
  1789. RMS_trough
  1790. Flat_factor
  1791. Peak_count
  1792. Bit_depth
  1793. Number_of_samples
  1794. Number_of_NaNs
  1795. Number_of_Infs
  1796. Number_of_denormals
  1797. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1798. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1799. For description what each key means read below.
  1800. @item reset
  1801. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1802. Default is disabled.
  1803. @item measure_perchannel
  1804. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1805. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1806. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1807. @item measure_overall
  1808. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1809. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1810. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1811. @end table
  1812. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1813. @table @option
  1814. @item DC offset
  1815. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1816. @item Min level
  1817. Minimal sample level.
  1818. @item Max level
  1819. Maximal sample level.
  1820. @item Min difference
  1821. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1822. @item Max difference
  1823. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1824. @item Mean difference
  1825. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1826. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1827. @item RMS difference
  1828. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1829. @item Peak level dB
  1830. @item RMS level dB
  1831. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1832. @item RMS peak dB
  1833. @item RMS trough dB
  1834. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1835. @item Crest factor
  1836. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1837. @item Flat factor
  1838. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1839. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1840. @item Peak count
  1841. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1842. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1843. @item Bit depth
  1844. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1845. @item Dynamic range
  1846. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1847. @item Zero crossings
  1848. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1849. @item Zero crossings rate
  1850. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1851. @end table
  1852. @section atempo
  1853. Adjust audio tempo.
  1854. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1855. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1856. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1857. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1858. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1859. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1860. desired product tempo.
  1861. @subsection Examples
  1862. @itemize
  1863. @item
  1864. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1865. @example
  1866. atempo=0.8
  1867. @end example
  1868. @item
  1869. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1870. @example
  1871. atempo=3
  1872. @end example
  1873. @item
  1874. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1875. @example
  1876. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1877. @end example
  1878. @end itemize
  1879. @subsection Commands
  1880. This filter supports the following commands:
  1881. @table @option
  1882. @item tempo
  1883. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1884. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1885. @end table
  1886. @section atrim
  1887. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1888. It accepts the following parameters:
  1889. @table @option
  1890. @item start
  1891. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1892. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1893. @item end
  1894. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1895. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1896. the last sample in the output.
  1897. @item start_pts
  1898. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1899. instead of seconds.
  1900. @item end_pts
  1901. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1902. of seconds.
  1903. @item duration
  1904. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1905. @item start_sample
  1906. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1907. @item end_sample
  1908. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1909. @end table
  1910. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1911. duration specifications; see
  1912. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1913. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1914. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1915. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1916. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1917. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1918. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1919. atrim filter.
  1920. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1921. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1922. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1923. filters.
  1924. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1925. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1926. Examples:
  1927. @itemize
  1928. @item
  1929. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1930. @example
  1931. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1932. @end example
  1933. @item
  1934. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1935. @example
  1936. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1937. @end example
  1938. @end itemize
  1939. @section axcorrelate
  1940. Calculate normalized cross-correlation between two input audio streams.
  1941. Resulted samples are always between -1 and 1 inclusive.
  1942. If result is 1 it means two input samples are highly correlated in that selected segment.
  1943. Result 0 means they are not correlated at all.
  1944. If result is -1 it means two input samples are out of phase, which means they cancel each
  1945. other.
  1946. The filter accepts the following options:
  1947. @table @option
  1948. @item size
  1949. Set size of segment over which cross-correlation is calculated.
  1950. Default is 256. Allowed range is from 2 to 131072.
  1951. @item algo
  1952. Set algorithm for cross-correlation. Can be @code{slow} or @code{fast}.
  1953. Default is @code{slow}. Fast algorithm assumes mean values over any given segment
  1954. are always zero and thus need much less calculations to make.
  1955. This is generally not true, but is valid for typical audio streams.
  1956. @end table
  1957. @subsection Examples
  1958. @itemize
  1959. @item
  1960. Calculate correlation between channels in stereo audio stream:
  1961. @example
  1962. ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af channelsplit,axcorrelate=size=1024:algo=fast correlation.wav
  1963. @end example
  1964. @end itemize
  1965. @section bandpass
  1966. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1967. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1968. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1969. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1970. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1971. The filter accepts the following options:
  1972. @table @option
  1973. @item frequency, f
  1974. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1975. @item csg
  1976. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1977. @item width_type, t
  1978. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1979. @table @option
  1980. @item h
  1981. Hz
  1982. @item q
  1983. Q-Factor
  1984. @item o
  1985. octave
  1986. @item s
  1987. slope
  1988. @item k
  1989. kHz
  1990. @end table
  1991. @item width, w
  1992. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1993. @item mix, m
  1994. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1995. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1996. @item channels, c
  1997. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1998. @item normalize, n
  1999. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2000. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2001. @end table
  2002. @subsection Commands
  2003. This filter supports the following commands:
  2004. @table @option
  2005. @item frequency, f
  2006. Change bandpass frequency.
  2007. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2008. @item width_type, t
  2009. Change bandpass width_type.
  2010. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2011. @item width, w
  2012. Change bandpass width.
  2013. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2014. @item mix, m
  2015. Change bandpass mix.
  2016. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2017. @end table
  2018. @section bandreject
  2019. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  2020. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  2021. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2022. The filter accepts the following options:
  2023. @table @option
  2024. @item frequency, f
  2025. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2026. @item width_type, t
  2027. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2028. @table @option
  2029. @item h
  2030. Hz
  2031. @item q
  2032. Q-Factor
  2033. @item o
  2034. octave
  2035. @item s
  2036. slope
  2037. @item k
  2038. kHz
  2039. @end table
  2040. @item width, w
  2041. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2042. @item mix, m
  2043. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2044. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2045. @item channels, c
  2046. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2047. @item normalize, n
  2048. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2049. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2050. @end table
  2051. @subsection Commands
  2052. This filter supports the following commands:
  2053. @table @option
  2054. @item frequency, f
  2055. Change bandreject frequency.
  2056. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2057. @item width_type, t
  2058. Change bandreject width_type.
  2059. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2060. @item width, w
  2061. Change bandreject width.
  2062. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2063. @item mix, m
  2064. Change bandreject mix.
  2065. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2066. @end table
  2067. @section bass, lowshelf
  2068. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2069. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2070. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2071. The filter accepts the following options:
  2072. @table @option
  2073. @item gain, g
  2074. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2075. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2076. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2077. @item frequency, f
  2078. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2079. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2080. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2081. @item width_type, t
  2082. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2083. @table @option
  2084. @item h
  2085. Hz
  2086. @item q
  2087. Q-Factor
  2088. @item o
  2089. octave
  2090. @item s
  2091. slope
  2092. @item k
  2093. kHz
  2094. @end table
  2095. @item width, w
  2096. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2097. @item mix, m
  2098. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2099. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2100. @item channels, c
  2101. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2102. @item normalize, n
  2103. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2104. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2105. @end table
  2106. @subsection Commands
  2107. This filter supports the following commands:
  2108. @table @option
  2109. @item frequency, f
  2110. Change bass frequency.
  2111. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2112. @item width_type, t
  2113. Change bass width_type.
  2114. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2115. @item width, w
  2116. Change bass width.
  2117. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2118. @item gain, g
  2119. Change bass gain.
  2120. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2121. @item mix, m
  2122. Change bass mix.
  2123. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2124. @end table
  2125. @section biquad
  2126. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2127. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2128. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2129. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2130. available are filtered.
  2131. @subsection Commands
  2132. This filter supports the following commands:
  2133. @table @option
  2134. @item a0
  2135. @item a1
  2136. @item a2
  2137. @item b0
  2138. @item b1
  2139. @item b2
  2140. Change biquad parameter.
  2141. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2142. @item mix, m
  2143. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2144. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2145. @item channels, c
  2146. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2147. @item normalize, n
  2148. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2149. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2150. @end table
  2151. @section bs2b
  2152. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2153. stereo audio records.
  2154. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2155. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2156. It accepts the following parameters:
  2157. @table @option
  2158. @item profile
  2159. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2160. @table @option
  2161. @item default
  2162. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2163. @item cmoy
  2164. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2165. @item jmeier
  2166. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2167. @end table
  2168. @item fcut
  2169. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2170. @item feed
  2171. Feed level (in Hz).
  2172. @end table
  2173. @section channelmap
  2174. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2175. It accepts the following parameters:
  2176. @table @option
  2177. @item map
  2178. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2179. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2180. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2181. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2182. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2183. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2184. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2185. @item channel_layout
  2186. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2187. @end table
  2188. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2189. output channels, preserving indices.
  2190. @subsection Examples
  2191. @itemize
  2192. @item
  2193. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2194. @example
  2195. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2196. @end example
  2197. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2198. the input.
  2199. @item
  2200. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2201. @example
  2202. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2203. @end example
  2204. @end itemize
  2205. @section channelsplit
  2206. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2207. It accepts the following parameters:
  2208. @table @option
  2209. @item channel_layout
  2210. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2211. @item channels
  2212. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2213. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2214. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2215. @end table
  2216. @subsection Examples
  2217. @itemize
  2218. @item
  2219. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2220. @example
  2221. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2222. @end example
  2223. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2224. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2225. @item
  2226. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2227. @example
  2228. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2229. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2230. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2231. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2232. side_right.wav
  2233. @end example
  2234. @item
  2235. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2236. @example
  2237. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2238. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2239. @end example
  2240. @end itemize
  2241. @section chorus
  2242. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2243. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2244. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2245. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2246. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2247. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2248. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2249. off key.
  2250. It accepts the following parameters:
  2251. @table @option
  2252. @item in_gain
  2253. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2254. @item out_gain
  2255. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2256. @item delays
  2257. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2258. @item decays
  2259. Set decays.
  2260. @item speeds
  2261. Set speeds.
  2262. @item depths
  2263. Set depths.
  2264. @end table
  2265. @subsection Examples
  2266. @itemize
  2267. @item
  2268. A single delay:
  2269. @example
  2270. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2271. @end example
  2272. @item
  2273. Two delays:
  2274. @example
  2275. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2276. @end example
  2277. @item
  2278. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2279. @example
  2280. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2281. @end example
  2282. @end itemize
  2283. @section compand
  2284. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2285. It accepts the following parameters:
  2286. @table @option
  2287. @item attacks
  2288. @item decays
  2289. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2290. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2291. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2292. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2293. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2294. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2295. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2296. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2297. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2298. @item points
  2299. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2300. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2301. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2302. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2303. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2304. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2305. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2306. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2307. @item soft-knee
  2308. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2309. @item gain
  2310. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2311. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2312. It defaults to 0.
  2313. @item volume
  2314. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2315. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2316. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2317. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2318. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2319. @item delay
  2320. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2321. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2322. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2323. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2324. @end table
  2325. @subsection Examples
  2326. @itemize
  2327. @item
  2328. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2329. noisy environment:
  2330. @example
  2331. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2332. @end example
  2333. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2334. @example
  2335. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2336. @end example
  2337. @item
  2338. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2339. @example
  2340. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2341. @end example
  2342. @item
  2343. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2344. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2345. @example
  2346. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2347. @end example
  2348. @item
  2349. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2350. @example
  2351. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2352. @end example
  2353. @item
  2354. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2355. @example
  2356. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2357. @end example
  2358. @item
  2359. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2360. @example
  2361. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2362. @end example
  2363. @item
  2364. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2365. @example
  2366. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2367. @end example
  2368. @item
  2369. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2370. @example
  2371. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2372. @end example
  2373. @item
  2374. Compressor/Gate:
  2375. @example
  2376. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2377. @end example
  2378. @item
  2379. Expander:
  2380. @example
  2381. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2382. @end example
  2383. @item
  2384. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2385. @example
  2386. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2387. @end example
  2388. @item
  2389. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2390. @example
  2391. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2392. @end example
  2393. @item
  2394. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2395. @example
  2396. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2397. @end example
  2398. @item
  2399. Soft limiter:
  2400. @example
  2401. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2402. @end example
  2403. @end itemize
  2404. @section compensationdelay
  2405. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2406. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2407. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2408. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2409. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2410. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2411. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2412. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2413. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2414. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2415. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2416. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2417. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2418. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2419. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2420. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2421. @table @option
  2422. @item mm
  2423. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2424. Default is 0.
  2425. @item cm
  2426. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2427. Default is 0.
  2428. @item m
  2429. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2430. Default is 0.
  2431. @item dry
  2432. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2433. Default is 0.
  2434. @item wet
  2435. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2436. Default is 1.
  2437. @item temp
  2438. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2439. Default is 20.
  2440. @end table
  2441. @section crossfeed
  2442. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2443. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2444. audio recording.
  2445. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2446. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2447. The filter accepts the following options:
  2448. @table @option
  2449. @item strength
  2450. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2451. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2452. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2453. @item range
  2454. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2455. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2456. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2457. @item level_in
  2458. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2459. @item level_out
  2460. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2461. @end table
  2462. @section crystalizer
  2463. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2464. The filter accepts the following options:
  2465. @table @option
  2466. @item i
  2467. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2468. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2469. @item c
  2470. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2471. @end table
  2472. @subsection Commands
  2473. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2474. @section dcshift
  2475. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2476. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2477. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2478. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2479. a signal has a DC offset.
  2480. @table @option
  2481. @item shift
  2482. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2483. the audio.
  2484. @item limitergain
  2485. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2486. used to prevent clipping.
  2487. @end table
  2488. @section deesser
  2489. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2490. @table @option
  2491. @item i
  2492. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2493. Default is 0.
  2494. @item m
  2495. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2496. Default is 0.5.
  2497. @item f
  2498. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2499. Default is 0.5.
  2500. @item s
  2501. Set the output mode.
  2502. It accepts the following values:
  2503. @table @option
  2504. @item i
  2505. Pass input unchanged.
  2506. @item o
  2507. Pass ess filtered out.
  2508. @item e
  2509. Pass only ess.
  2510. Default value is @var{o}.
  2511. @end table
  2512. @end table
  2513. @section drmeter
  2514. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2515. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2516. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2517. and is very compressed.
  2518. The filter accepts the following options:
  2519. @table @option
  2520. @item length
  2521. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2522. Default is 3 seconds.
  2523. @end table
  2524. @section dynaudnorm
  2525. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2526. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2527. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2528. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2529. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2530. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2531. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2532. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2533. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2534. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2535. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2536. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2537. @table @option
  2538. @item framelen, f
  2539. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2540. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2541. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2542. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2543. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2544. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2545. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2546. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2547. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2548. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2549. been found to give good results with most files.
  2550. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2551. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2552. @item gausssize, g
  2553. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2554. number. Default is 31.
  2555. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2556. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2557. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2558. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2559. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2560. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2561. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2562. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2563. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2564. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2565. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2566. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2567. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2568. @item peak, p
  2569. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2570. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2571. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2572. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2573. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2574. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2575. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2576. @item maxgain, m
  2577. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2578. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2579. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2580. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2581. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2582. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2583. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2584. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2585. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2586. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2587. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2588. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2589. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2590. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2591. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2592. value.
  2593. @item targetrms, r
  2594. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2595. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2596. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2597. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2598. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2599. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2600. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2601. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2602. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2603. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2604. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2605. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2606. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2607. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2608. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2609. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2610. @item coupling, n
  2611. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2612. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2613. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2614. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2615. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2616. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2617. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2618. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2619. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2620. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2621. @item correctdc, c
  2622. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2623. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2624. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2625. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2626. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2627. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2628. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2629. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2630. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2631. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2632. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2633. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2634. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2635. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2636. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2637. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2638. between neighbouring frames.
  2639. @item altboundary, b
  2640. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2641. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2642. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2643. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2644. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2645. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2646. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2647. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2648. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2649. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2650. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2651. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2652. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2653. @item compress, s
  2654. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2655. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2656. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2657. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2658. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2659. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2660. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2661. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2662. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2663. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2664. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2665. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2666. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2667. frame.
  2668. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2669. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2670. @item threshold, t
  2671. Set the target threshold value. This specifies the lowest permissible
  2672. magnitude level for the audio input which will be normalized.
  2673. If input frame volume is above this value frame will be normalized.
  2674. Otherwise frame may not be normalized at all. The default value is set
  2675. to 0, which means all input frames will be normalized.
  2676. This option is mostly useful if digital noise is not wanted to be amplified.
  2677. @end table
  2678. @subsection Commands
  2679. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2680. @section earwax
  2681. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2682. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2683. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2684. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2685. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2686. Ported from SoX.
  2687. @section equalizer
  2688. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2689. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2690. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2691. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2692. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2693. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2694. The filter accepts the following options:
  2695. @table @option
  2696. @item frequency, f
  2697. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2698. @item width_type, t
  2699. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2700. @table @option
  2701. @item h
  2702. Hz
  2703. @item q
  2704. Q-Factor
  2705. @item o
  2706. octave
  2707. @item s
  2708. slope
  2709. @item k
  2710. kHz
  2711. @end table
  2712. @item width, w
  2713. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2714. @item gain, g
  2715. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2716. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2717. @item mix, m
  2718. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2719. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2720. @item channels, c
  2721. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2722. @item normalize, n
  2723. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2724. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2725. @end table
  2726. @subsection Examples
  2727. @itemize
  2728. @item
  2729. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2730. @example
  2731. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2732. @end example
  2733. @item
  2734. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2735. @example
  2736. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2737. @end example
  2738. @end itemize
  2739. @subsection Commands
  2740. This filter supports the following commands:
  2741. @table @option
  2742. @item frequency, f
  2743. Change equalizer frequency.
  2744. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2745. @item width_type, t
  2746. Change equalizer width_type.
  2747. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2748. @item width, w
  2749. Change equalizer width.
  2750. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2751. @item gain, g
  2752. Change equalizer gain.
  2753. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2754. @item mix, m
  2755. Change equalizer mix.
  2756. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2757. @end table
  2758. @section extrastereo
  2759. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2760. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2761. The filter accepts the following options:
  2762. @table @option
  2763. @item m
  2764. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2765. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2766. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2767. @item c
  2768. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2769. @end table
  2770. @subsection Commands
  2771. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2772. @section firequalizer
  2773. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2774. The filter accepts the following option:
  2775. @table @option
  2776. @item gain
  2777. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2778. @table @option
  2779. @item f
  2780. the evaluated frequency
  2781. @item sr
  2782. sample rate
  2783. @item ch
  2784. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2785. @item chid
  2786. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2787. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2788. @item chs
  2789. number of channels
  2790. @item chlayout
  2791. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2792. @end table
  2793. and functions:
  2794. @table @option
  2795. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2796. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2797. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2798. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2799. @end table
  2800. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2801. @item gain_entry
  2802. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2803. contain functions:
  2804. @table @option
  2805. @item entry(f, g)
  2806. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2807. @end table
  2808. This option is also available as command.
  2809. @item delay
  2810. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2811. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2812. @item accuracy
  2813. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2814. Default is @code{5}.
  2815. @item wfunc
  2816. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2817. @table @option
  2818. @item rectangular
  2819. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2820. @item hann
  2821. hann window (default)
  2822. @item hamming
  2823. hamming window
  2824. @item blackman
  2825. blackman window
  2826. @item nuttall3
  2827. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2828. @item mnuttall3
  2829. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2830. @item nuttall
  2831. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2832. @item bnuttall
  2833. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2834. @item bharris
  2835. blackman-harris window
  2836. @item tukey
  2837. tukey window
  2838. @end table
  2839. @item fixed
  2840. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2841. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2842. @item multi
  2843. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2844. @item zero_phase
  2845. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2846. Default is disabled.
  2847. @item scale
  2848. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2849. @table @option
  2850. @item linlin
  2851. linear frequency, linear gain
  2852. @item linlog
  2853. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2854. @item loglin
  2855. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2856. @item loglog
  2857. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2858. @end table
  2859. @item dumpfile
  2860. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2861. @item dumpscale
  2862. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2863. Default is linlog.
  2864. @item fft2
  2865. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2866. Default is disabled.
  2867. @item min_phase
  2868. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2869. @end table
  2870. @subsection Examples
  2871. @itemize
  2872. @item
  2873. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2874. @example
  2875. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2876. @end example
  2877. @item
  2878. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2879. @example
  2880. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2881. @end example
  2882. @item
  2883. custom equalization:
  2884. @example
  2885. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2886. @end example
  2887. @item
  2888. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2889. @example
  2890. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2891. @end example
  2892. @item
  2893. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2894. @example
  2895. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2896. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2897. @end example
  2898. @end itemize
  2899. @section flanger
  2900. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2901. The filter accepts the following options:
  2902. @table @option
  2903. @item delay
  2904. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2905. @item depth
  2906. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2907. @item regen
  2908. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2909. Default value is 0.
  2910. @item width
  2911. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2912. Default value is 71.
  2913. @item speed
  2914. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2915. @item shape
  2916. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2917. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2918. @item phase
  2919. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2920. Default value is 25.
  2921. @item interp
  2922. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2923. Default is @var{linear}.
  2924. @end table
  2925. @section haas
  2926. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2927. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2928. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2929. stretches its stereo image.
  2930. The filter accepts the following options:
  2931. @table @option
  2932. @item level_in
  2933. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2934. @item level_out
  2935. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2936. @item side_gain
  2937. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2938. @item middle_source
  2939. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2940. @table @samp
  2941. @item left
  2942. Pick left channel.
  2943. @item right
  2944. Pick right channel.
  2945. @item mid
  2946. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  2947. @item side
  2948. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  2949. @end table
  2950. @item middle_phase
  2951. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  2952. @item left_delay
  2953. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  2954. @item left_balance
  2955. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  2956. @item left_gain
  2957. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2958. @item left_phase
  2959. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  2960. @item right_delay
  2961. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  2962. @item right_balance
  2963. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  2964. @item right_gain
  2965. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2966. @item right_phase
  2967. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  2968. @end table
  2969. @section hdcd
  2970. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2971. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2972. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2973. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2974. @example
  2975. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2976. @end example
  2977. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2978. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2979. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2980. @example
  2981. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2982. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2983. @end example
  2984. The filter accepts the following options:
  2985. @table @option
  2986. @item disable_autoconvert
  2987. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2988. @item process_stereo
  2989. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2990. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2991. @item cdt_ms
  2992. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2993. @item force_pe
  2994. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2995. @item analyze_mode
  2996. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2997. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2998. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2999. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  3000. Modes are:
  3001. @table @samp
  3002. @item 0, off
  3003. Disabled
  3004. @item 1, lle
  3005. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  3006. @item 2, pe
  3007. Samples where peak extend occurs
  3008. @item 3, cdt
  3009. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  3010. @item 4, tgm
  3011. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  3012. @end table
  3013. @end table
  3014. @section headphone
  3015. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3016. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  3017. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  3018. one stereo input stream is needed.
  3019. The filter accepts the following options:
  3020. @table @option
  3021. @item map
  3022. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  3023. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  3024. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  3025. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  3026. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  3027. @item gain
  3028. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3029. @item type
  3030. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3031. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3032. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3033. Default is @var{freq}.
  3034. @item lfe
  3035. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3036. @item size
  3037. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  3038. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  3039. @item hrir
  3040. Set format of hrir stream.
  3041. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  3042. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  3043. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  3044. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  3045. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  3046. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  3047. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  3048. stream.
  3049. @end table
  3050. @subsection Examples
  3051. @itemize
  3052. @item
  3053. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3054. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  3055. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  3056. @example
  3057. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  3058. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  3059. output.wav
  3060. @end example
  3061. @item
  3062. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3063. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  3064. @example
  3065. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  3066. output.wav
  3067. @end example
  3068. @end itemize
  3069. @section highpass
  3070. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3071. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3072. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3073. The filter accepts the following options:
  3074. @table @option
  3075. @item frequency, f
  3076. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3077. @item poles, p
  3078. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3079. @item width_type, t
  3080. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3081. @table @option
  3082. @item h
  3083. Hz
  3084. @item q
  3085. Q-Factor
  3086. @item o
  3087. octave
  3088. @item s
  3089. slope
  3090. @item k
  3091. kHz
  3092. @end table
  3093. @item width, w
  3094. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3095. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3096. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3097. @item mix, m
  3098. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3099. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3100. @item channels, c
  3101. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3102. @item normalize, n
  3103. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3104. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3105. @end table
  3106. @subsection Commands
  3107. This filter supports the following commands:
  3108. @table @option
  3109. @item frequency, f
  3110. Change highpass frequency.
  3111. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3112. @item width_type, t
  3113. Change highpass width_type.
  3114. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3115. @item width, w
  3116. Change highpass width.
  3117. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3118. @item mix, m
  3119. Change highpass mix.
  3120. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3121. @end table
  3122. @section join
  3123. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3124. It accepts the following parameters:
  3125. @table @option
  3126. @item inputs
  3127. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3128. @item channel_layout
  3129. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3130. @item map
  3131. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3132. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3133. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3134. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3135. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3136. channel.
  3137. @end table
  3138. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3139. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3140. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3141. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3142. @example
  3143. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3144. @end example
  3145. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3146. @example
  3147. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3148. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3149. out
  3150. @end example
  3151. @section ladspa
  3152. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3153. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3154. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3155. @table @option
  3156. @item file, f
  3157. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3158. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3159. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3160. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3161. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3162. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3163. @item plugin, p
  3164. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3165. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3166. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3167. @item controls, c
  3168. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3169. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3170. threshold or gain).
  3171. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3172. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3173. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3174. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3175. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3176. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3177. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3178. their valid ranges are printed.
  3179. @item sample_rate, s
  3180. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3181. zero inputs.
  3182. @item nb_samples, n
  3183. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3184. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3185. @item duration, d
  3186. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3187. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3188. for the accepted syntax.
  3189. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3190. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3191. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3192. supposed to be generated forever.
  3193. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3194. @end table
  3195. @subsection Examples
  3196. @itemize
  3197. @item
  3198. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3199. @example
  3200. ladspa=file=amp
  3201. @end example
  3202. @item
  3203. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3204. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3205. @example
  3206. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3207. @end example
  3208. @item
  3209. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3210. plugin library:
  3211. @example
  3212. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3213. @end example
  3214. @item
  3215. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3216. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3217. @example
  3218. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3219. @end example
  3220. @item
  3221. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3222. @example
  3223. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3224. @end example
  3225. @item
  3226. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3227. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3228. @example
  3229. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3230. @end example
  3231. @item
  3232. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3233. @example
  3234. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3235. @end example
  3236. @item
  3237. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3238. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3239. @example
  3240. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3241. @end example
  3242. @item
  3243. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3244. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3245. @example
  3246. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3247. @end example
  3248. @item
  3249. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3250. (CAPS) library:
  3251. @example
  3252. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3253. @end example
  3254. @item
  3255. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3256. @example
  3257. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3258. @end example
  3259. @item
  3260. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3261. @example
  3262. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3263. @end example
  3264. @item
  3265. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3266. @example
  3267. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3268. @end example
  3269. @end itemize
  3270. @subsection Commands
  3271. This filter supports the following commands:
  3272. @table @option
  3273. @item cN
  3274. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3275. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3276. @end table
  3277. @section loudnorm
  3278. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3279. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3280. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. In dynamic mode, to accurately
  3281. detect true peaks, the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz.
  3282. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3283. The filter accepts the following options:
  3284. @table @option
  3285. @item I, i
  3286. Set integrated loudness target.
  3287. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3288. @item LRA, lra
  3289. Set loudness range target.
  3290. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3291. @item TP, tp
  3292. Set maximum true peak.
  3293. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3294. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3295. Measured IL of input file.
  3296. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3297. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3298. Measured LRA of input file.
  3299. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3300. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3301. Measured true peak of input file.
  3302. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3303. @item measured_thresh
  3304. Measured threshold of input file.
  3305. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3306. @item offset
  3307. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3308. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3309. @item linear
  3310. Normalize by linearly scaling the source audio.
  3311. @code{measured_I}, @code{measured_LRA}, @code{measured_TP},
  3312. and @code{measured_thresh} must all be specified. Target LRA shouldn't
  3313. be lower than source LRA and the change in integrated loudness shouldn't
  3314. result in a true peak which exceeds the target TP. If any of these
  3315. conditions aren't met, normalization mode will revert to @var{dynamic}.
  3316. Options are @code{true} or @code{false}. Default is @code{true}.
  3317. @item dual_mono
  3318. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3319. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3320. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3321. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3322. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3323. @item print_format
  3324. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3325. Default value is none.
  3326. @end table
  3327. @section lowpass
  3328. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3329. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3330. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3331. The filter accepts the following options:
  3332. @table @option
  3333. @item frequency, f
  3334. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3335. @item poles, p
  3336. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3337. @item width_type, t
  3338. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3339. @table @option
  3340. @item h
  3341. Hz
  3342. @item q
  3343. Q-Factor
  3344. @item o
  3345. octave
  3346. @item s
  3347. slope
  3348. @item k
  3349. kHz
  3350. @end table
  3351. @item width, w
  3352. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3353. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3354. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3355. @item mix, m
  3356. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3357. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3358. @item channels, c
  3359. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3360. @item normalize, n
  3361. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3362. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3363. @end table
  3364. @subsection Examples
  3365. @itemize
  3366. @item
  3367. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3368. @example
  3369. lowpass=c=LFE
  3370. @end example
  3371. @end itemize
  3372. @subsection Commands
  3373. This filter supports the following commands:
  3374. @table @option
  3375. @item frequency, f
  3376. Change lowpass frequency.
  3377. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3378. @item width_type, t
  3379. Change lowpass width_type.
  3380. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3381. @item width, w
  3382. Change lowpass width.
  3383. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3384. @item mix, m
  3385. Change lowpass mix.
  3386. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3387. @end table
  3388. @section lv2
  3389. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3390. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3391. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3392. @table @option
  3393. @item plugin, p
  3394. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3395. @item controls, c
  3396. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3397. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3398. threshold or gain).
  3399. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3400. their valid ranges are printed.
  3401. @item sample_rate, s
  3402. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3403. zero inputs.
  3404. @item nb_samples, n
  3405. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3406. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3407. @item duration, d
  3408. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3409. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3410. for the accepted syntax.
  3411. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3412. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3413. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3414. supposed to be generated forever.
  3415. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3416. @end table
  3417. @subsection Examples
  3418. @itemize
  3419. @item
  3420. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3421. @example
  3422. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3423. @end example
  3424. @item
  3425. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3426. @example
  3427. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3428. @end example
  3429. @item
  3430. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3431. @example
  3432. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3433. @end example
  3434. @end itemize
  3435. @section mcompand
  3436. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3437. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3438. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3439. response when absent compander action.
  3440. It accepts the following parameters:
  3441. @table @option
  3442. @item args
  3443. This option syntax is:
  3444. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3445. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3446. @end table
  3447. @anchor{pan}
  3448. @section pan
  3449. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3450. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3451. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3452. stream.
  3453. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3454. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3455. @table @option
  3456. @item l
  3457. output channel layout or number of channels
  3458. @item outdef
  3459. output channel specification, of the form:
  3460. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3461. @item out_name
  3462. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3463. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3464. @item gain
  3465. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3466. @item in_name
  3467. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3468. named and numbered input channels
  3469. @end table
  3470. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3471. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3472. avoiding clipping noise.
  3473. @subsection Mixing examples
  3474. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3475. factor for the left channel:
  3476. @example
  3477. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3478. @end example
  3479. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3480. 7-channels surround:
  3481. @example
  3482. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3483. @end example
  3484. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3485. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3486. needs.
  3487. @subsection Remapping examples
  3488. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3489. @itemize
  3490. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3491. @item only one input per channel output,
  3492. @end itemize
  3493. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3494. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3495. remapping.
  3496. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3497. dropping the extra channels:
  3498. @example
  3499. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3500. @end example
  3501. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3502. and keep the input channel layout:
  3503. @example
  3504. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3505. @end example
  3506. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3507. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3508. @example
  3509. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3510. @end example
  3511. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3512. front left and right:
  3513. @example
  3514. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3515. @end example
  3516. @section replaygain
  3517. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3518. outputs it unchanged.
  3519. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3520. @section resample
  3521. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3522. not meant to be used directly.
  3523. @section rubberband
  3524. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3525. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3526. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3527. The filter accepts the following options:
  3528. @table @option
  3529. @item tempo
  3530. Set tempo scale factor.
  3531. @item pitch
  3532. Set pitch scale factor.
  3533. @item transients
  3534. Set transients detector.
  3535. Possible values are:
  3536. @table @var
  3537. @item crisp
  3538. @item mixed
  3539. @item smooth
  3540. @end table
  3541. @item detector
  3542. Set detector.
  3543. Possible values are:
  3544. @table @var
  3545. @item compound
  3546. @item percussive
  3547. @item soft
  3548. @end table
  3549. @item phase
  3550. Set phase.
  3551. Possible values are:
  3552. @table @var
  3553. @item laminar
  3554. @item independent
  3555. @end table
  3556. @item window
  3557. Set processing window size.
  3558. Possible values are:
  3559. @table @var
  3560. @item standard
  3561. @item short
  3562. @item long
  3563. @end table
  3564. @item smoothing
  3565. Set smoothing.
  3566. Possible values are:
  3567. @table @var
  3568. @item off
  3569. @item on
  3570. @end table
  3571. @item formant
  3572. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3573. Possible values are:
  3574. @table @var
  3575. @item shifted
  3576. @item preserved
  3577. @end table
  3578. @item pitchq
  3579. Set pitch quality.
  3580. Possible values are:
  3581. @table @var
  3582. @item quality
  3583. @item speed
  3584. @item consistency
  3585. @end table
  3586. @item channels
  3587. Set channels.
  3588. Possible values are:
  3589. @table @var
  3590. @item apart
  3591. @item together
  3592. @end table
  3593. @end table
  3594. @subsection Commands
  3595. This filter supports the following commands:
  3596. @table @option
  3597. @item tempo
  3598. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3599. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3600. @item pitch
  3601. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3602. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3603. @end table
  3604. @section sidechaincompress
  3605. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3606. detected signal using second input signal.
  3607. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3608. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3609. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3610. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3611. The filter accepts the following options:
  3612. @table @option
  3613. @item level_in
  3614. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3615. @item mode
  3616. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3617. Default is @code{downward}.
  3618. @item threshold
  3619. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3620. reduction of first stream.
  3621. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3622. @item ratio
  3623. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3624. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3625. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3626. @item attack
  3627. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3628. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3629. @item release
  3630. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3631. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3632. @item makeup
  3633. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3634. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3635. @item knee
  3636. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3637. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3638. @item link
  3639. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3640. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3641. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3642. @item detection
  3643. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3644. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3645. @item level_sc
  3646. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3647. @item mix
  3648. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3649. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3650. @end table
  3651. @subsection Commands
  3652. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  3653. @subsection Examples
  3654. @itemize
  3655. @item
  3656. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3657. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3658. merged with 2nd input:
  3659. @example
  3660. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3661. @end example
  3662. @end itemize
  3663. @section sidechaingate
  3664. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3665. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3666. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3667. threshold.
  3668. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3669. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3670. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3671. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3672. guitar.
  3673. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3674. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3675. The filter accepts the following options:
  3676. @table @option
  3677. @item level_in
  3678. Set input level before filtering.
  3679. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3680. @item mode
  3681. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3682. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3683. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3684. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3685. @item range
  3686. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3687. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3688. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3689. @item threshold
  3690. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3691. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3692. @item ratio
  3693. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3694. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3695. @item attack
  3696. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3697. reduction stops.
  3698. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3699. @item release
  3700. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3701. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3702. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3703. @item makeup
  3704. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3705. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3706. @item knee
  3707. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3708. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3709. @item detection
  3710. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3711. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3712. @item link
  3713. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3714. the reduction.
  3715. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3716. @item level_sc
  3717. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3718. @end table
  3719. @section silencedetect
  3720. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3721. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3722. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3723. minimum detected noise duration.
  3724. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  3725. @code{lavfi.silence_start} or @code{lavfi.silence_start.X} metadata key
  3726. is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection
  3727. duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.
  3728. The @code{lavfi.silence_duration} or @code{lavfi.silence_duration.X}
  3729. and @code{lavfi.silence_end} or @code{lavfi.silence_end.X} metadata
  3730. keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If @option{mono} is
  3731. enabled, and each channel is evaluated separately, the @code{.X}
  3732. suffixed keys are used, and @code{X} corresponds to the channel number.
  3733. The filter accepts the following options:
  3734. @table @option
  3735. @item noise, n
  3736. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3737. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3738. @item duration, d
  3739. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See
  3740. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3741. for the accepted syntax.
  3742. @item mono, m
  3743. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3744. @end table
  3745. @subsection Examples
  3746. @itemize
  3747. @item
  3748. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3749. @example
  3750. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3751. @end example
  3752. @item
  3753. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3754. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3755. @example
  3756. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3757. @end example
  3758. @end itemize
  3759. @section silenceremove
  3760. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3761. The filter accepts the following options:
  3762. @table @option
  3763. @item start_periods
  3764. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3765. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3766. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3767. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3768. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3769. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3770. Default value is @code{0}.
  3771. @item start_duration
  3772. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3773. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3774. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3775. @item start_threshold
  3776. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3777. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3778. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3779. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3780. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3781. @item start_silence
  3782. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3783. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3784. as silence.
  3785. @item start_mode
  3786. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3787. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3788. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3789. stopped trimming of silence.
  3790. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3791. stopped trimming of silence.
  3792. @item stop_periods
  3793. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3794. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3795. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3796. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3797. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3798. in the middle of the audio.
  3799. Default value is @code{0}.
  3800. @item stop_duration
  3801. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3802. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3803. the audio.
  3804. Default value is @code{0}.
  3805. @item stop_threshold
  3806. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3807. the end of audio.
  3808. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3809. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3810. @item stop_silence
  3811. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3812. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3813. as silence.
  3814. @item stop_mode
  3815. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3816. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3817. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3818. stopped trimming of silence.
  3819. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3820. stopped trimming of silence.
  3821. @item detection
  3822. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3823. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3824. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3825. @item window
  3826. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3827. of samples for detecting silence.
  3828. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3829. @end table
  3830. @subsection Examples
  3831. @itemize
  3832. @item
  3833. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3834. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3835. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3836. @example
  3837. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3838. @end example
  3839. @item
  3840. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3841. second of silence in audio:
  3842. @example
  3843. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3844. @end example
  3845. @item
  3846. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3847. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3848. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3849. @example
  3850. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3851. @end example
  3852. @end itemize
  3853. @section sofalizer
  3854. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3855. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3856. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3857. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3858. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3859. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3860. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3861. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3862. The filter accepts the following options:
  3863. @table @option
  3864. @item sofa
  3865. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3866. @item gain
  3867. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3868. @item rotation
  3869. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3870. @item elevation
  3871. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3872. @item radius
  3873. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3874. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3875. @item type
  3876. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3877. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3878. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3879. Default is @var{freq}.
  3880. @item speakers
  3881. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3882. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3883. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3884. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3885. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3886. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3887. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3888. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3889. @item lfegain
  3890. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3891. @item framesize
  3892. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3893. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3894. is set to @var{freq}.
  3895. @item normalize
  3896. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3897. By default is enabled.
  3898. @item interpolate
  3899. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3900. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3901. @item minphase
  3902. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3903. @item anglestep
  3904. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3905. @item radstep
  3906. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3907. @end table
  3908. @subsection Examples
  3909. @itemize
  3910. @item
  3911. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3912. @example
  3913. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3914. @end example
  3915. @item
  3916. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3917. @example
  3918. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3919. @end example
  3920. @item
  3921. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3922. and also with custom gain:
  3923. @example
  3924. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3925. @end example
  3926. @end itemize
  3927. @section stereotools
  3928. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3929. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3930. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3931. The filter accepts the following options:
  3932. @table @option
  3933. @item level_in
  3934. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3935. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3936. @item level_out
  3937. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3938. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3939. @item balance_in
  3940. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3941. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3942. @item balance_out
  3943. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3944. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3945. @item softclip
  3946. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  3947. clipping. Disabled by default.
  3948. @item mutel
  3949. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3950. @item muter
  3951. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3952. @item phasel
  3953. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3954. @item phaser
  3955. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3956. @item mode
  3957. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  3958. @table @samp
  3959. @item lr>lr
  3960. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  3961. @item lr>ms
  3962. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  3963. @item ms>lr
  3964. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  3965. @item lr>ll
  3966. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  3967. @item lr>rr
  3968. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  3969. @item lr>l+r
  3970. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  3971. @item lr>rl
  3972. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  3973. @item ms>ll
  3974. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  3975. @item ms>rr
  3976. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  3977. @end table
  3978. @item slev
  3979. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  3980. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3981. @item sbal
  3982. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  3983. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3984. @item mlev
  3985. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  3986. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3987. @item mpan
  3988. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3989. @item base
  3990. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  3991. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3992. @item delay
  3993. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  3994. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  3995. @item sclevel
  3996. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  3997. @item phase
  3998. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  3999. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  4000. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  4001. Can be one of the following:
  4002. @table @samp
  4003. @item balance
  4004. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  4005. Gain is raised up to 1.
  4006. @item amplitude
  4007. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  4008. @item power
  4009. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  4010. @end table
  4011. @end table
  4012. @subsection Examples
  4013. @itemize
  4014. @item
  4015. Apply karaoke like effect:
  4016. @example
  4017. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  4018. @end example
  4019. @item
  4020. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  4021. @example
  4022. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  4023. @end example
  4024. @end itemize
  4025. @section stereowiden
  4026. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  4027. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  4028. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  4029. The filter accepts the following options:
  4030. @table @option
  4031. @item delay
  4032. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  4033. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  4034. @item feedback
  4035. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  4036. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  4037. effect. Default is 0.3.
  4038. @item crossfeed
  4039. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  4040. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  4041. channels. Default is 0.3.
  4042. @item drymix
  4043. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  4044. @end table
  4045. @subsection Commands
  4046. This filter supports the all above options except @code{delay} as @ref{commands}.
  4047. @section superequalizer
  4048. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  4049. The filter accepts the following options:
  4050. @table @option
  4051. @item 1b
  4052. Set 65Hz band gain.
  4053. @item 2b
  4054. Set 92Hz band gain.
  4055. @item 3b
  4056. Set 131Hz band gain.
  4057. @item 4b
  4058. Set 185Hz band gain.
  4059. @item 5b
  4060. Set 262Hz band gain.
  4061. @item 6b
  4062. Set 370Hz band gain.
  4063. @item 7b
  4064. Set 523Hz band gain.
  4065. @item 8b
  4066. Set 740Hz band gain.
  4067. @item 9b
  4068. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  4069. @item 10b
  4070. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  4071. @item 11b
  4072. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  4073. @item 12b
  4074. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  4075. @item 13b
  4076. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  4077. @item 14b
  4078. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  4079. @item 15b
  4080. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  4081. @item 16b
  4082. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  4083. @item 17b
  4084. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  4085. @item 18b
  4086. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  4087. @end table
  4088. @section surround
  4089. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  4090. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  4091. The filter accepts the following options:
  4092. @table @option
  4093. @item chl_out
  4094. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4095. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4096. for the required syntax.
  4097. @item chl_in
  4098. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4099. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4100. for the required syntax.
  4101. @item level_in
  4102. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4103. @item level_out
  4104. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4105. @item lfe
  4106. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4107. @item lfe_low
  4108. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4109. @item lfe_high
  4110. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4111. @item lfe_mode
  4112. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4113. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4114. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4115. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4116. @item angle
  4117. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4118. Default is @var{90}.
  4119. @item fc_in
  4120. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4121. @item fc_out
  4122. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4123. @item fl_in
  4124. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4125. @item fl_out
  4126. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4127. @item fr_in
  4128. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4129. @item fr_out
  4130. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4131. @item sl_in
  4132. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4133. @item sl_out
  4134. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4135. @item sr_in
  4136. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4137. @item sr_out
  4138. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4139. @item bl_in
  4140. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4141. @item bl_out
  4142. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4143. @item br_in
  4144. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4145. @item br_out
  4146. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4147. @item bc_in
  4148. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4149. @item bc_out
  4150. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4151. @item lfe_in
  4152. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4153. @item lfe_out
  4154. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4155. @item allx
  4156. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4157. @item ally
  4158. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4159. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4160. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4161. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4162. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4163. @item win_size
  4164. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4165. @item win_func
  4166. Set window function.
  4167. It accepts the following values:
  4168. @table @samp
  4169. @item rect
  4170. @item bartlett
  4171. @item hann, hanning
  4172. @item hamming
  4173. @item blackman
  4174. @item welch
  4175. @item flattop
  4176. @item bharris
  4177. @item bnuttall
  4178. @item bhann
  4179. @item sine
  4180. @item nuttall
  4181. @item lanczos
  4182. @item gauss
  4183. @item tukey
  4184. @item dolph
  4185. @item cauchy
  4186. @item parzen
  4187. @item poisson
  4188. @item bohman
  4189. @end table
  4190. Default is @code{hann}.
  4191. @item overlap
  4192. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4193. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4194. @end table
  4195. @section treble, highshelf
  4196. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4197. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4198. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4199. The filter accepts the following options:
  4200. @table @option
  4201. @item gain, g
  4202. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4203. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4204. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4205. @item frequency, f
  4206. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4207. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4208. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4209. @item width_type, t
  4210. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4211. @table @option
  4212. @item h
  4213. Hz
  4214. @item q
  4215. Q-Factor
  4216. @item o
  4217. octave
  4218. @item s
  4219. slope
  4220. @item k
  4221. kHz
  4222. @end table
  4223. @item width, w
  4224. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4225. @item mix, m
  4226. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4227. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4228. @item channels, c
  4229. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4230. @item normalize, n
  4231. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  4232. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  4233. @end table
  4234. @subsection Commands
  4235. This filter supports the following commands:
  4236. @table @option
  4237. @item frequency, f
  4238. Change treble frequency.
  4239. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4240. @item width_type, t
  4241. Change treble width_type.
  4242. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4243. @item width, w
  4244. Change treble width.
  4245. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4246. @item gain, g
  4247. Change treble gain.
  4248. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4249. @item mix, m
  4250. Change treble mix.
  4251. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4252. @end table
  4253. @section tremolo
  4254. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4255. The filter accepts the following options:
  4256. @table @option
  4257. @item f
  4258. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4259. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4260. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4261. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4262. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4263. @item d
  4264. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4265. Default value is 0.5.
  4266. @end table
  4267. @section vibrato
  4268. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4269. The filter accepts the following options:
  4270. @table @option
  4271. @item f
  4272. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4273. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4274. @item d
  4275. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4276. Default value is 0.5.
  4277. @end table
  4278. @section volume
  4279. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4280. It accepts the following parameters:
  4281. @table @option
  4282. @item volume
  4283. Set audio volume expression.
  4284. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4285. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4286. @example
  4287. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4288. @end example
  4289. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4290. @item precision
  4291. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4292. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4293. precision of the volume scaling.
  4294. @table @option
  4295. @item fixed
  4296. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4297. @item float
  4298. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4299. @item double
  4300. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4301. @end table
  4302. @item replaygain
  4303. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4304. @table @option
  4305. @item drop
  4306. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4307. @item ignore
  4308. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4309. @item track
  4310. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4311. @item album
  4312. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4313. @end table
  4314. @item replaygain_preamp
  4315. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4316. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4317. @item replaygain_noclip
  4318. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4319. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4320. @item eval
  4321. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4322. It accepts the following values:
  4323. @table @samp
  4324. @item once
  4325. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4326. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4327. @item frame
  4328. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4329. @end table
  4330. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4331. @end table
  4332. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4333. @table @option
  4334. @item n
  4335. frame number (starting at zero)
  4336. @item nb_channels
  4337. number of channels
  4338. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4339. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4340. @item nb_samples
  4341. number of samples in the current frame
  4342. @item pos
  4343. original frame position in the file
  4344. @item pts
  4345. frame PTS
  4346. @item sample_rate
  4347. sample rate
  4348. @item startpts
  4349. PTS at start of stream
  4350. @item startt
  4351. time at start of stream
  4352. @item t
  4353. frame time
  4354. @item tb
  4355. timestamp timebase
  4356. @item volume
  4357. last set volume value
  4358. @end table
  4359. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4360. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4361. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4362. @subsection Commands
  4363. This filter supports the following commands:
  4364. @table @option
  4365. @item volume
  4366. Modify the volume expression.
  4367. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4368. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4369. value.
  4370. @end table
  4371. @subsection Examples
  4372. @itemize
  4373. @item
  4374. Halve the input audio volume:
  4375. @example
  4376. volume=volume=0.5
  4377. volume=volume=1/2
  4378. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4379. @end example
  4380. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4381. omitted, for example like in:
  4382. @example
  4383. volume=0.5
  4384. @end example
  4385. @item
  4386. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4387. @example
  4388. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4389. @end example
  4390. @item
  4391. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4392. @example
  4393. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4394. @end example
  4395. @end itemize
  4396. @section volumedetect
  4397. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4398. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4399. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4400. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4401. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4402. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4403. the samples).
  4404. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4405. @subsection Examples
  4406. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4407. @example
  4408. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4409. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4410. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4411. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4412. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4413. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4414. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4415. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4416. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4417. @end example
  4418. It means that:
  4419. @itemize
  4420. @item
  4421. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4422. @item
  4423. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4424. @item
  4425. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4426. @end itemize
  4427. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4428. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4429. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4430. @chapter Audio Sources
  4431. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4432. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4433. @section abuffer
  4434. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4435. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4436. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4437. It accepts the following parameters:
  4438. @table @option
  4439. @item time_base
  4440. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4441. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4442. @item sample_rate
  4443. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4444. @item sample_fmt
  4445. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4446. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4447. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4448. @item channel_layout
  4449. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4450. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4451. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4452. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4453. @item channels
  4454. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4455. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4456. must be consistent.
  4457. @end table
  4458. @subsection Examples
  4459. @example
  4460. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4461. @end example
  4462. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4463. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4464. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4465. equivalent to:
  4466. @example
  4467. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4468. @end example
  4469. @section aevalsrc
  4470. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4471. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4472. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4473. audio signal.
  4474. This source accepts the following options:
  4475. @table @option
  4476. @item exprs
  4477. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4478. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4479. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4480. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4481. @item channel_layout, c
  4482. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4483. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4484. @item duration, d
  4485. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4486. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4487. for the accepted syntax.
  4488. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4489. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4490. complete frame.
  4491. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4492. supposed to be generated forever.
  4493. @item nb_samples, n
  4494. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4495. default to 1024.
  4496. @item sample_rate, s
  4497. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4498. @end table
  4499. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4500. @table @option
  4501. @item n
  4502. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4503. @item t
  4504. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4505. @item s
  4506. sample rate
  4507. @end table
  4508. @subsection Examples
  4509. @itemize
  4510. @item
  4511. Generate silence:
  4512. @example
  4513. aevalsrc=0
  4514. @end example
  4515. @item
  4516. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4517. 8000 Hz:
  4518. @example
  4519. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4520. @end example
  4521. @item
  4522. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4523. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4524. @example
  4525. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4526. @end example
  4527. @item
  4528. Generate white noise:
  4529. @example
  4530. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4531. @end example
  4532. @item
  4533. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4534. @example
  4535. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4536. @end example
  4537. @item
  4538. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4539. @example
  4540. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4541. @end example
  4542. @end itemize
  4543. @section afirsrc
  4544. Generate a FIR coefficients using frequency sampling method.
  4545. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4546. The filter accepts the following options:
  4547. @table @option
  4548. @item taps, t
  4549. Set number of filter coefficents in output audio stream.
  4550. Default value is 1025.
  4551. @item frequency, f
  4552. Set frequency points from where magnitude and phase are set.
  4553. This must be in non decreasing order, and first element must be 0, while last element
  4554. must be 1. Elements are separated by white spaces.
  4555. @item magnitude, m
  4556. Set magnitude value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4557. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4558. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4559. @item phase, p
  4560. Set phase value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4561. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4562. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4563. @item sample_rate, r
  4564. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4565. @item nb_samples, n
  4566. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4567. @item win_func, w
  4568. Set window function. Default is blackman.
  4569. @end table
  4570. @section anullsrc
  4571. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4572. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4573. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4574. synth filter).
  4575. This source accepts the following options:
  4576. @table @option
  4577. @item channel_layout, cl
  4578. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4579. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4580. is "stereo".
  4581. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4582. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4583. channel layout values.
  4584. @item sample_rate, r
  4585. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4586. @item nb_samples, n
  4587. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4588. @end table
  4589. @subsection Examples
  4590. @itemize
  4591. @item
  4592. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4593. @example
  4594. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4595. @end example
  4596. @item
  4597. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4598. @example
  4599. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4600. @end example
  4601. @end itemize
  4602. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4603. @section flite
  4604. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4605. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4606. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4607. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4608. The filter accepts the following options:
  4609. @table @option
  4610. @item list_voices
  4611. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4612. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4613. @item nb_samples, n
  4614. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4615. @item textfile
  4616. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4617. @item text
  4618. Set the text to speak.
  4619. @item voice, v
  4620. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4621. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4622. @end table
  4623. @subsection Examples
  4624. @itemize
  4625. @item
  4626. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4627. standard flite voice:
  4628. @example
  4629. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4630. @end example
  4631. @item
  4632. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4633. @example
  4634. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4635. @end example
  4636. @item
  4637. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4638. @example
  4639. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4640. @end example
  4641. @item
  4642. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4643. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4644. @example
  4645. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4646. @end example
  4647. @end itemize
  4648. For more information about libflite, check:
  4649. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4650. @section anoisesrc
  4651. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4652. The filter accepts the following options:
  4653. @table @option
  4654. @item sample_rate, r
  4655. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4656. @item amplitude, a
  4657. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4658. is 1.0.
  4659. @item duration, d
  4660. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4661. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4662. @item color, colour, c
  4663. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4664. blue, violet and velvet. Default color is white.
  4665. @item seed, s
  4666. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4667. @item nb_samples, n
  4668. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4669. @end table
  4670. @subsection Examples
  4671. @itemize
  4672. @item
  4673. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4674. @example
  4675. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4676. @end example
  4677. @end itemize
  4678. @section hilbert
  4679. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4680. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4681. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4682. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4683. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4684. The filter accepts the following options:
  4685. @table @option
  4686. @item sample_rate, s
  4687. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4688. @item taps, t
  4689. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4690. @item nb_samples, n
  4691. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4692. @item win_func, w
  4693. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4694. @end table
  4695. @section sinc
  4696. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4697. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4698. The filter accepts the following options:
  4699. @table @option
  4700. @item sample_rate, r
  4701. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4702. @item nb_samples, n
  4703. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4704. @item hp
  4705. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4706. @item lp
  4707. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4708. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4709. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4710. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4711. @item phase
  4712. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4713. @item beta
  4714. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4715. @item att
  4716. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4717. @item round
  4718. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4719. @item hptaps
  4720. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4721. @item lptaps
  4722. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4723. @end table
  4724. @section sine
  4725. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4726. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4727. The filter accepts the following options:
  4728. @table @option
  4729. @item frequency, f
  4730. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4731. @item beep_factor, b
  4732. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4733. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4734. @item sample_rate, r
  4735. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4736. @item duration, d
  4737. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4738. @item samples_per_frame
  4739. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4740. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4741. @table @option
  4742. @item n
  4743. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4744. @item pts
  4745. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4746. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4747. @item t
  4748. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4749. @item TB
  4750. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4751. @end table
  4752. Default is @code{1024}.
  4753. @end table
  4754. @subsection Examples
  4755. @itemize
  4756. @item
  4757. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4758. @example
  4759. sine
  4760. @end example
  4761. @item
  4762. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4763. @example
  4764. sine=220:4:d=5
  4765. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4766. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4767. @end example
  4768. @item
  4769. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4770. pattern:
  4771. @example
  4772. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4773. @end example
  4774. @end itemize
  4775. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4776. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4777. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4778. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4779. @section abuffersink
  4780. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4781. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4782. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4783. or the options system.
  4784. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4785. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4786. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4787. @section anullsink
  4788. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4789. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4790. tools.
  4791. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4792. @chapter Video Filters
  4793. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4794. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4795. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4796. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4797. build.
  4798. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4799. @section addroi
  4800. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4801. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4802. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4803. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4804. applying the filter multiple times.
  4805. @table @option
  4806. @item x
  4807. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4808. @item y
  4809. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4810. @item w
  4811. Region width in pixels.
  4812. @item h
  4813. Region height in pixels.
  4814. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4815. and may contain the following variables:
  4816. @table @option
  4817. @item iw
  4818. Width of the input frame.
  4819. @item ih
  4820. Height of the input frame.
  4821. @end table
  4822. @item qoffset
  4823. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4824. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4825. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4826. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4827. (greater quantisation).
  4828. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4829. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4830. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4831. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4832. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4833. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4834. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4835. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4836. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4837. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4838. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4839. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4840. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4841. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4842. @item clear
  4843. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4844. frame before adding the new one.
  4845. @end table
  4846. @subsection Examples
  4847. @itemize
  4848. @item
  4849. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4850. @example
  4851. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4852. @end example
  4853. @item
  4854. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4855. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4856. the frame).
  4857. @example
  4858. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4859. @end example
  4860. @end itemize
  4861. @section alphaextract
  4862. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4863. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4864. @section alphamerge
  4865. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4866. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4867. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4868. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4869. channel.
  4870. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4871. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4872. @example
  4873. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4874. @end example
  4875. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4876. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4877. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4878. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4879. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4880. @section amplify
  4881. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4882. same pixel location.
  4883. This filter accepts the following options:
  4884. @table @option
  4885. @item radius
  4886. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4887. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4888. @item factor
  4889. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4890. @item threshold
  4891. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4892. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4893. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4894. @item tolerance
  4895. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4896. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4897. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4898. @item low
  4899. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4900. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4901. @item high
  4902. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4903. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4904. @item planes
  4905. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4906. @end table
  4907. @subsection Commands
  4908. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4909. @table @option
  4910. @item factor
  4911. @item threshold
  4912. @item tolerance
  4913. @item low
  4914. @item high
  4915. @item planes
  4916. @end table
  4917. @section ass
  4918. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4919. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4920. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4921. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4922. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4923. @table @option
  4924. @item shaping
  4925. Set the shaping engine
  4926. Available values are:
  4927. @table @samp
  4928. @item auto
  4929. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4930. @item simple
  4931. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4932. @item complex
  4933. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4934. @end table
  4935. The default is @code{auto}.
  4936. @end table
  4937. @section atadenoise
  4938. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4939. The filter accepts the following options:
  4940. @table @option
  4941. @item 0a
  4942. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  4943. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4944. @item 0b
  4945. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  4946. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4947. @item 1a
  4948. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4949. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4950. @item 1b
  4951. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4952. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4953. @item 2a
  4954. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4955. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4956. @item 2b
  4957. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4958. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4959. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  4960. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  4961. @item s
  4962. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  4963. number in range [5, 129].
  4964. @item p
  4965. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  4966. @item a
  4967. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  4968. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  4969. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  4970. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  4971. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  4972. @end table
  4973. @subsection Commands
  4974. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options except option @code{s}.
  4975. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4976. @section avgblur
  4977. Apply average blur filter.
  4978. The filter accepts the following options:
  4979. @table @option
  4980. @item sizeX
  4981. Set horizontal radius size.
  4982. @item planes
  4983. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  4984. @item sizeY
  4985. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  4986. Default is @code{0}.
  4987. @end table
  4988. @subsection Commands
  4989. This filter supports same commands as options.
  4990. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4991. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4992. value.
  4993. @section bbox
  4994. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  4995. luminance plane.
  4996. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  4997. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  4998. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  4999. log.
  5000. The filter accepts the following option:
  5001. @table @option
  5002. @item min_val
  5003. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  5004. @end table
  5005. @section bilateral
  5006. Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.
  5007. The filter accepts the following options:
  5008. @table @option
  5009. @item sigmaS
  5010. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.
  5011. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default is 0.1.
  5012. @item sigmaR
  5013. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.
  5014. Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.
  5015. @item planes
  5016. Set planes to filter. Default is first only.
  5017. @end table
  5018. @section bitplanenoise
  5019. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  5020. The filter accepts the following options:
  5021. @table @option
  5022. @item bitplane
  5023. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  5024. @item filter
  5025. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  5026. Default is disabled.
  5027. @end table
  5028. @section blackdetect
  5029. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  5030. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  5031. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  5032. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  5033. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5034. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5035. The filter accepts the following options:
  5036. @table @option
  5037. @item black_min_duration, d
  5038. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  5039. be a non-negative floating point number.
  5040. Default value is 2.0.
  5041. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  5042. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  5043. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  5044. @example
  5045. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  5046. @end example
  5047. for which a picture is considered black.
  5048. Default value is 0.98.
  5049. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  5050. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  5051. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  5052. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  5053. the following equation:
  5054. @example
  5055. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  5056. @end example
  5057. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  5058. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  5059. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  5060. Default value is 0.10.
  5061. @end table
  5062. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  5063. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  5064. @example
  5065. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  5066. @end example
  5067. @section blackframe
  5068. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  5069. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  5070. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  5071. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  5072. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5073. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5074. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  5075. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  5076. are below the threshold value.
  5077. It accepts the following parameters:
  5078. @table @option
  5079. @item amount
  5080. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  5081. @code{98}.
  5082. @item threshold, thresh
  5083. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  5084. @code{32}.
  5085. @end table
  5086. @section blend, tblend
  5087. Blend two video frames into each other.
  5088. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  5089. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  5090. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  5091. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  5092. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  5093. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  5094. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5095. @table @option
  5096. @item c0_mode
  5097. @item c1_mode
  5098. @item c2_mode
  5099. @item c3_mode
  5100. @item all_mode
  5101. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5102. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  5103. Available values for component modes are:
  5104. @table @samp
  5105. @item addition
  5106. @item grainmerge
  5107. @item and
  5108. @item average
  5109. @item burn
  5110. @item darken
  5111. @item difference
  5112. @item grainextract
  5113. @item divide
  5114. @item dodge
  5115. @item freeze
  5116. @item exclusion
  5117. @item extremity
  5118. @item glow
  5119. @item hardlight
  5120. @item hardmix
  5121. @item heat
  5122. @item lighten
  5123. @item linearlight
  5124. @item multiply
  5125. @item multiply128
  5126. @item negation
  5127. @item normal
  5128. @item or
  5129. @item overlay
  5130. @item phoenix
  5131. @item pinlight
  5132. @item reflect
  5133. @item screen
  5134. @item softlight
  5135. @item subtract
  5136. @item vividlight
  5137. @item xor
  5138. @end table
  5139. @item c0_opacity
  5140. @item c1_opacity
  5141. @item c2_opacity
  5142. @item c3_opacity
  5143. @item all_opacity
  5144. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5145. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5146. @item c0_expr
  5147. @item c1_expr
  5148. @item c2_expr
  5149. @item c3_expr
  5150. @item all_expr
  5151. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5152. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5153. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5154. @table @option
  5155. @item N
  5156. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5157. @item X
  5158. @item Y
  5159. the coordinates of the current sample
  5160. @item W
  5161. @item H
  5162. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5163. @item SW
  5164. @item SH
  5165. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5166. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5167. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5168. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5169. @item T
  5170. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5171. @item TOP, A
  5172. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5173. @item BOTTOM, B
  5174. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5175. @end table
  5176. @end table
  5177. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5178. @subsection Examples
  5179. @itemize
  5180. @item
  5181. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5182. @example
  5183. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5184. @end example
  5185. @item
  5186. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5187. @example
  5188. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5189. @end example
  5190. @item
  5191. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5192. @example
  5193. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5194. @end example
  5195. @item
  5196. Apply uncover left effect:
  5197. @example
  5198. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5199. @end example
  5200. @item
  5201. Apply uncover down effect:
  5202. @example
  5203. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5204. @end example
  5205. @item
  5206. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5207. @example
  5208. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5209. @end example
  5210. @item
  5211. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5212. @example
  5213. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5214. @end example
  5215. @item
  5216. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5217. @example
  5218. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5219. @end example
  5220. @end itemize
  5221. @section bm3d
  5222. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5223. The filter accepts the following options.
  5224. @table @option
  5225. @item sigma
  5226. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5227. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5228. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5229. according to the source.
  5230. @item block
  5231. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5232. @item bstep
  5233. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5234. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5235. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5236. @item group
  5237. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5238. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5239. in single group.
  5240. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5241. @item range
  5242. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5243. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5244. @item mstep
  5245. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5246. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5247. @item thmse
  5248. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5249. INT32_MAX.
  5250. @item hdthr
  5251. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5252. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5253. domain.
  5254. @item estim
  5255. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5256. Default is @code{basic}.
  5257. @item ref
  5258. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5259. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5260. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5261. @item planes
  5262. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5263. @end table
  5264. @subsection Examples
  5265. @itemize
  5266. @item
  5267. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5268. @example
  5269. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5270. @end example
  5271. @item
  5272. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5273. @example
  5274. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5275. @end example
  5276. @item
  5277. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5278. @example
  5279. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5280. @end example
  5281. @item
  5282. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5283. @example
  5284. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5285. @end example
  5286. @end itemize
  5287. @section boxblur
  5288. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5289. It accepts the following parameters:
  5290. @table @option
  5291. @item luma_radius, lr
  5292. @item luma_power, lp
  5293. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5294. @item chroma_power, cp
  5295. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5296. @item alpha_power, ap
  5297. @end table
  5298. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5299. @table @option
  5300. @item luma_radius, lr
  5301. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5302. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5303. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5304. corresponding input plane.
  5305. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5306. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5307. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5308. planes.
  5309. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5310. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5311. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5312. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5313. @table @option
  5314. @item w
  5315. @item h
  5316. The input width and height in pixels.
  5317. @item cw
  5318. @item ch
  5319. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5320. @item hsub
  5321. @item vsub
  5322. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5323. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5324. @end table
  5325. @item luma_power, lp
  5326. @item chroma_power, cp
  5327. @item alpha_power, ap
  5328. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5329. corresponding plane.
  5330. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5331. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5332. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5333. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5334. @end table
  5335. @subsection Examples
  5336. @itemize
  5337. @item
  5338. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5339. set to 2:
  5340. @example
  5341. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5342. boxblur=2:1
  5343. @end example
  5344. @item
  5345. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5346. @example
  5347. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5348. @end example
  5349. @item
  5350. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5351. @example
  5352. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5353. @end example
  5354. @end itemize
  5355. @section bwdif
  5356. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5357. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5358. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5359. interpolation algorithms.
  5360. It accepts the following parameters:
  5361. @table @option
  5362. @item mode
  5363. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5364. @table @option
  5365. @item 0, send_frame
  5366. Output one frame for each frame.
  5367. @item 1, send_field
  5368. Output one frame for each field.
  5369. @end table
  5370. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5371. @item parity
  5372. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5373. of the following values:
  5374. @table @option
  5375. @item 0, tff
  5376. Assume the top field is first.
  5377. @item 1, bff
  5378. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5379. @item -1, auto
  5380. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5381. @end table
  5382. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5383. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5384. top field first will be assumed.
  5385. @item deint
  5386. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5387. values:
  5388. @table @option
  5389. @item 0, all
  5390. Deinterlace all frames.
  5391. @item 1, interlaced
  5392. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5393. @end table
  5394. The default value is @code{all}.
  5395. @end table
  5396. @section chromahold
  5397. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5398. The filter accepts the following options:
  5399. @table @option
  5400. @item color
  5401. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5402. @item similarity
  5403. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5404. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5405. @item blend
  5406. Blend percentage.
  5407. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5408. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5409. @item yuv
  5410. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5411. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5412. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5413. @end table
  5414. @subsection Commands
  5415. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5416. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5417. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5418. value.
  5419. @section chromakey
  5420. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5421. The filter accepts the following options:
  5422. @table @option
  5423. @item color
  5424. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5425. @item similarity
  5426. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5427. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5428. @item blend
  5429. Blend percentage.
  5430. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5431. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5432. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5433. @item yuv
  5434. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5435. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5436. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5437. @end table
  5438. @subsection Commands
  5439. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5440. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5441. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5442. value.
  5443. @subsection Examples
  5444. @itemize
  5445. @item
  5446. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5447. @example
  5448. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5449. @end example
  5450. @item
  5451. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5452. @example
  5453. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5454. @end example
  5455. @end itemize
  5456. @section chromashift
  5457. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5458. The filter accepts the following options:
  5459. @table @option
  5460. @item cbh
  5461. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5462. @item cbv
  5463. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5464. @item crh
  5465. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5466. @item crv
  5467. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5468. @item edge
  5469. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5470. @end table
  5471. @subsection Commands
  5472. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5473. @section ciescope
  5474. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5475. The filter accepts the following options:
  5476. @table @option
  5477. @item system
  5478. Set color system.
  5479. @table @samp
  5480. @item ntsc, 470m
  5481. @item ebu, 470bg
  5482. @item smpte
  5483. @item 240m
  5484. @item apple
  5485. @item widergb
  5486. @item cie1931
  5487. @item rec709, hdtv
  5488. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5489. @item dcip3
  5490. @end table
  5491. @item cie
  5492. Set CIE system.
  5493. @table @samp
  5494. @item xyy
  5495. @item ucs
  5496. @item luv
  5497. @end table
  5498. @item gamuts
  5499. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5500. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5501. @item size, s
  5502. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5503. @item intensity, i
  5504. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5505. @item contrast
  5506. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5507. @item corrgamma
  5508. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5509. @item showwhite
  5510. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5511. @item gamma
  5512. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5513. @end table
  5514. @section codecview
  5515. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5516. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5517. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5518. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5519. The filter accepts the following option:
  5520. @table @option
  5521. @item mv
  5522. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5523. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5524. @table @samp
  5525. @item pf
  5526. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5527. @item bf
  5528. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5529. @item bb
  5530. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5531. @end table
  5532. @item qp
  5533. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5534. @item mv_type, mvt
  5535. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5536. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5537. @table @samp
  5538. @item fp
  5539. forward predicted MVs
  5540. @item bp
  5541. backward predicted MVs
  5542. @end table
  5543. @item frame_type, ft
  5544. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5545. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5546. @table @samp
  5547. @item if
  5548. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5549. @item pf
  5550. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5551. @item bf
  5552. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5553. @end table
  5554. @end table
  5555. @subsection Examples
  5556. @itemize
  5557. @item
  5558. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5559. @example
  5560. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5561. @end example
  5562. @item
  5563. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5564. @example
  5565. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5566. @end example
  5567. @end itemize
  5568. @section colorbalance
  5569. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5570. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5571. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5572. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5573. value towards the complementary color.
  5574. The filter accepts the following options:
  5575. @table @option
  5576. @item rs
  5577. @item gs
  5578. @item bs
  5579. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5580. @item rm
  5581. @item gm
  5582. @item bm
  5583. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5584. @item rh
  5585. @item gh
  5586. @item bh
  5587. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5588. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5589. @item pl
  5590. Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.
  5591. @end table
  5592. @subsection Examples
  5593. @itemize
  5594. @item
  5595. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5596. @example
  5597. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5598. @end example
  5599. @end itemize
  5600. @subsection Commands
  5601. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5602. @section colorchannelmixer
  5603. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5604. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5605. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5606. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5607. @example
  5608. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5609. @end example
  5610. The filter accepts the following options:
  5611. @table @option
  5612. @item rr
  5613. @item rg
  5614. @item rb
  5615. @item ra
  5616. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5617. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5618. @item gr
  5619. @item gg
  5620. @item gb
  5621. @item ga
  5622. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5623. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5624. @item br
  5625. @item bg
  5626. @item bb
  5627. @item ba
  5628. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5629. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5630. @item ar
  5631. @item ag
  5632. @item ab
  5633. @item aa
  5634. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5635. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5636. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5637. @end table
  5638. @subsection Examples
  5639. @itemize
  5640. @item
  5641. Convert source to grayscale:
  5642. @example
  5643. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5644. @end example
  5645. @item
  5646. Simulate sepia tones:
  5647. @example
  5648. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5649. @end example
  5650. @end itemize
  5651. @subsection Commands
  5652. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5653. @section colorkey
  5654. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5655. The filter accepts the following options:
  5656. @table @option
  5657. @item color
  5658. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5659. @item similarity
  5660. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5661. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5662. @item blend
  5663. Blend percentage.
  5664. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5665. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5666. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5667. @end table
  5668. @subsection Examples
  5669. @itemize
  5670. @item
  5671. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5672. @example
  5673. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5674. @end example
  5675. @item
  5676. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5677. @example
  5678. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5679. @end example
  5680. @end itemize
  5681. @subsection Commands
  5682. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5683. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5684. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5685. value.
  5686. @section colorhold
  5687. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5688. The filter accepts the following options:
  5689. @table @option
  5690. @item color
  5691. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5692. @item similarity
  5693. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5694. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5695. @item blend
  5696. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5697. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5698. @end table
  5699. @subsection Commands
  5700. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5701. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5702. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5703. value.
  5704. @section colorlevels
  5705. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5706. The filter accepts the following options:
  5707. @table @option
  5708. @item rimin
  5709. @item gimin
  5710. @item bimin
  5711. @item aimin
  5712. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5713. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5714. @item rimax
  5715. @item gimax
  5716. @item bimax
  5717. @item aimax
  5718. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5719. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5720. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5721. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5722. @item romin
  5723. @item gomin
  5724. @item bomin
  5725. @item aomin
  5726. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5727. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5728. @item romax
  5729. @item gomax
  5730. @item bomax
  5731. @item aomax
  5732. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5733. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5734. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5735. @end table
  5736. @subsection Examples
  5737. @itemize
  5738. @item
  5739. Make video output darker:
  5740. @example
  5741. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5742. @end example
  5743. @item
  5744. Increase contrast:
  5745. @example
  5746. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5747. @end example
  5748. @item
  5749. Make video output lighter:
  5750. @example
  5751. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5752. @end example
  5753. @item
  5754. Increase brightness:
  5755. @example
  5756. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5757. @end example
  5758. @end itemize
  5759. @subsection Commands
  5760. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5761. @section colormatrix
  5762. Convert color matrix.
  5763. The filter accepts the following options:
  5764. @table @option
  5765. @item src
  5766. @item dst
  5767. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5768. specified.
  5769. The accepted values are:
  5770. @table @samp
  5771. @item bt709
  5772. BT.709
  5773. @item fcc
  5774. FCC
  5775. @item bt601
  5776. BT.601
  5777. @item bt470
  5778. BT.470
  5779. @item bt470bg
  5780. BT.470BG
  5781. @item smpte170m
  5782. SMPTE-170M
  5783. @item smpte240m
  5784. SMPTE-240M
  5785. @item bt2020
  5786. BT.2020
  5787. @end table
  5788. @end table
  5789. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5790. @example
  5791. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5792. @end example
  5793. @section colorspace
  5794. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5795. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5796. The filter accepts the following options:
  5797. @table @option
  5798. @anchor{all}
  5799. @item all
  5800. Specify all color properties at once.
  5801. The accepted values are:
  5802. @table @samp
  5803. @item bt470m
  5804. BT.470M
  5805. @item bt470bg
  5806. BT.470BG
  5807. @item bt601-6-525
  5808. BT.601-6 525
  5809. @item bt601-6-625
  5810. BT.601-6 625
  5811. @item bt709
  5812. BT.709
  5813. @item smpte170m
  5814. SMPTE-170M
  5815. @item smpte240m
  5816. SMPTE-240M
  5817. @item bt2020
  5818. BT.2020
  5819. @end table
  5820. @anchor{space}
  5821. @item space
  5822. Specify output colorspace.
  5823. The accepted values are:
  5824. @table @samp
  5825. @item bt709
  5826. BT.709
  5827. @item fcc
  5828. FCC
  5829. @item bt470bg
  5830. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5831. @item smpte170m
  5832. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5833. @item smpte240m
  5834. SMPTE-240M
  5835. @item ycgco
  5836. YCgCo
  5837. @item bt2020ncl
  5838. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5839. @end table
  5840. @anchor{trc}
  5841. @item trc
  5842. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5843. The accepted values are:
  5844. @table @samp
  5845. @item bt709
  5846. BT.709
  5847. @item bt470m
  5848. BT.470M
  5849. @item bt470bg
  5850. BT.470BG
  5851. @item gamma22
  5852. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5853. @item gamma28
  5854. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5855. @item smpte170m
  5856. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5857. @item smpte240m
  5858. SMPTE-240M
  5859. @item srgb
  5860. SRGB
  5861. @item iec61966-2-1
  5862. iec61966-2-1
  5863. @item iec61966-2-4
  5864. iec61966-2-4
  5865. @item xvycc
  5866. xvycc
  5867. @item bt2020-10
  5868. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5869. @item bt2020-12
  5870. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5871. @end table
  5872. @anchor{primaries}
  5873. @item primaries
  5874. Specify output color primaries.
  5875. The accepted values are:
  5876. @table @samp
  5877. @item bt709
  5878. BT.709
  5879. @item bt470m
  5880. BT.470M
  5881. @item bt470bg
  5882. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5883. @item smpte170m
  5884. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5885. @item smpte240m
  5886. SMPTE-240M
  5887. @item film
  5888. film
  5889. @item smpte431
  5890. SMPTE-431
  5891. @item smpte432
  5892. SMPTE-432
  5893. @item bt2020
  5894. BT.2020
  5895. @item jedec-p22
  5896. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5897. @end table
  5898. @anchor{range}
  5899. @item range
  5900. Specify output color range.
  5901. The accepted values are:
  5902. @table @samp
  5903. @item tv
  5904. TV (restricted) range
  5905. @item mpeg
  5906. MPEG (restricted) range
  5907. @item pc
  5908. PC (full) range
  5909. @item jpeg
  5910. JPEG (full) range
  5911. @end table
  5912. @item format
  5913. Specify output color format.
  5914. The accepted values are:
  5915. @table @samp
  5916. @item yuv420p
  5917. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5918. @item yuv420p10
  5919. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5920. @item yuv420p12
  5921. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5922. @item yuv422p
  5923. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  5924. @item yuv422p10
  5925. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  5926. @item yuv422p12
  5927. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  5928. @item yuv444p
  5929. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  5930. @item yuv444p10
  5931. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  5932. @item yuv444p12
  5933. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  5934. @end table
  5935. @item fast
  5936. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  5937. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  5938. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  5939. @item dither
  5940. Specify dithering mode.
  5941. The accepted values are:
  5942. @table @samp
  5943. @item none
  5944. No dithering
  5945. @item fsb
  5946. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  5947. @end table
  5948. @item wpadapt
  5949. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  5950. The accepted values are:
  5951. @table @samp
  5952. @item bradford
  5953. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  5954. @item vonkries
  5955. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  5956. @item identity
  5957. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  5958. @end table
  5959. @item iall
  5960. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  5961. @item ispace
  5962. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  5963. @item iprimaries
  5964. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  5965. @item itrc
  5966. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  5967. @item irange
  5968. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  5969. @end table
  5970. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  5971. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  5972. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  5973. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  5974. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  5975. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  5976. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  5977. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  5978. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5979. @example
  5980. colorspace=smpte240m
  5981. @end example
  5982. @section convolution
  5983. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  5984. The filter accepts the following options:
  5985. @table @option
  5986. @item 0m
  5987. @item 1m
  5988. @item 2m
  5989. @item 3m
  5990. Set matrix for each plane.
  5991. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  5992. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  5993. @item 0rdiv
  5994. @item 1rdiv
  5995. @item 2rdiv
  5996. @item 3rdiv
  5997. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  5998. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  5999. @item 0bias
  6000. @item 1bias
  6001. @item 2bias
  6002. @item 3bias
  6003. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  6004. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  6005. @item 0mode
  6006. @item 1mode
  6007. @item 2mode
  6008. @item 3mode
  6009. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  6010. Default is @var{square}.
  6011. @end table
  6012. @subsection Examples
  6013. @itemize
  6014. @item
  6015. Apply sharpen:
  6016. @example
  6017. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  6018. @end example
  6019. @item
  6020. Apply blur:
  6021. @example
  6022. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  6023. @end example
  6024. @item
  6025. Apply edge enhance:
  6026. @example
  6027. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  6028. @end example
  6029. @item
  6030. Apply edge detect:
  6031. @example
  6032. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  6033. @end example
  6034. @item
  6035. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  6036. @example
  6037. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  6038. @end example
  6039. @item
  6040. Apply emboss:
  6041. @example
  6042. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  6043. @end example
  6044. @end itemize
  6045. @section convolve
  6046. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6047. as impulse.
  6048. The filter accepts the following options:
  6049. @table @option
  6050. @item planes
  6051. Set which planes to process.
  6052. @item impulse
  6053. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6054. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6055. @end table
  6056. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6057. @section copy
  6058. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  6059. testing purposes.
  6060. @anchor{coreimage}
  6061. @section coreimage
  6062. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  6063. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  6064. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  6065. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  6066. the respective OSX.
  6067. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  6068. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  6069. with its options.
  6070. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  6071. @table @option
  6072. @item list_filters
  6073. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  6074. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  6075. values.
  6076. @example
  6077. list_filters=true
  6078. @end example
  6079. @item filter
  6080. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  6081. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  6082. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  6083. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  6084. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  6085. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  6086. filter.
  6087. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  6088. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  6089. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  6090. @example
  6091. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  6092. @end example
  6093. @item output_rect
  6094. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  6095. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  6096. @example
  6097. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  6098. @end example
  6099. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  6100. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  6101. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  6102. @example
  6103. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  6104. @end example
  6105. @end table
  6106. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  6107. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  6108. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  6109. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  6110. usable as intended.
  6111. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  6112. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  6113. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  6114. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  6115. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  6116. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  6117. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  6118. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  6119. output image.
  6120. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  6121. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  6122. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  6123. @subsection Examples
  6124. @itemize
  6125. @item
  6126. List all filters available:
  6127. @example
  6128. coreimage=list_filters=true
  6129. @end example
  6130. @item
  6131. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  6132. @example
  6133. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  6134. @end example
  6135. @item
  6136. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  6137. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  6138. @example
  6139. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  6140. @end example
  6141. @item
  6142. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  6143. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  6144. @example
  6145. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  6146. @end example
  6147. @end itemize
  6148. @section cover_rect
  6149. Cover a rectangular object
  6150. It accepts the following options:
  6151. @table @option
  6152. @item cover
  6153. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6154. @item mode
  6155. Set covering mode.
  6156. It accepts the following values:
  6157. @table @samp
  6158. @item cover
  6159. cover it by the supplied image
  6160. @item blur
  6161. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6162. @end table
  6163. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6164. @end table
  6165. @subsection Examples
  6166. @itemize
  6167. @item
  6168. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6169. @example
  6170. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6171. @end example
  6172. @end itemize
  6173. @section crop
  6174. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6175. It accepts the following parameters:
  6176. @table @option
  6177. @item w, out_w
  6178. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6179. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6180. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6181. @item h, out_h
  6182. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6183. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6184. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6185. @item x
  6186. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6187. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6188. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6189. @item y
  6190. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6191. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6192. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6193. @item keep_aspect
  6194. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6195. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6196. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6197. @item exact
  6198. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6199. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6200. It defaults to 0.
  6201. @end table
  6202. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6203. expressions containing the following constants:
  6204. @table @option
  6205. @item x
  6206. @item y
  6207. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6208. each new frame.
  6209. @item in_w
  6210. @item in_h
  6211. The input width and height.
  6212. @item iw
  6213. @item ih
  6214. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6215. @item out_w
  6216. @item out_h
  6217. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6218. @item ow
  6219. @item oh
  6220. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6221. @item a
  6222. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6223. @item sar
  6224. input sample aspect ratio
  6225. @item dar
  6226. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6227. @item hsub
  6228. @item vsub
  6229. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6230. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6231. @item n
  6232. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6233. @item pos
  6234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6235. @item t
  6236. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6237. @end table
  6238. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6239. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6240. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6241. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6242. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6243. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6244. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6245. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6246. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6247. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6248. @subsection Examples
  6249. @itemize
  6250. @item
  6251. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6252. @example
  6253. crop=100:100:12:34
  6254. @end example
  6255. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6256. @example
  6257. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6258. @end example
  6259. @item
  6260. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6261. @example
  6262. crop=100:100
  6263. @end example
  6264. @item
  6265. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6266. @example
  6267. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6268. @end example
  6269. @item
  6270. Crop the input video central square:
  6271. @example
  6272. crop=out_w=in_h
  6273. crop=in_h
  6274. @end example
  6275. @item
  6276. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6277. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6278. corner of the input image.
  6279. @example
  6280. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6281. @end example
  6282. @item
  6283. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6284. the top and bottom borders
  6285. @example
  6286. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6287. @end example
  6288. @item
  6289. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6290. @example
  6291. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6292. @end example
  6293. @item
  6294. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6295. @example
  6296. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6297. @end example
  6298. @item
  6299. Apply trembling effect:
  6300. @example
  6301. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6302. @end example
  6303. @item
  6304. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6305. @example
  6306. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6307. @end example
  6308. @item
  6309. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6310. @example
  6311. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6312. @end example
  6313. @end itemize
  6314. @subsection Commands
  6315. This filter supports the following commands:
  6316. @table @option
  6317. @item w, out_w
  6318. @item h, out_h
  6319. @item x
  6320. @item y
  6321. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6322. in the input video.
  6323. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6324. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6325. value.
  6326. @end table
  6327. @section cropdetect
  6328. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6329. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6330. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6331. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6332. It accepts the following parameters:
  6333. @table @option
  6334. @item limit
  6335. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6336. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6337. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6338. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6339. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6340. @item round
  6341. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6342. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6343. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6344. encoding to most video codecs.
  6345. @item reset_count, reset
  6346. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6347. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6348. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6349. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6350. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6351. playback.
  6352. @end table
  6353. @anchor{cue}
  6354. @section cue
  6355. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6356. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6357. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6358. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6359. input.
  6360. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6361. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6362. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6363. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6364. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6365. some use cases.
  6366. @table @option
  6367. @item cue
  6368. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6369. @item preroll
  6370. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6371. @item buffer
  6372. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6373. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6374. @end table
  6375. @anchor{curves}
  6376. @section curves
  6377. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6378. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6379. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6380. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6381. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6382. the output frame.
  6383. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6384. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6385. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6386. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6387. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6388. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6389. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6390. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6391. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6392. The filter accepts the following options:
  6393. @table @option
  6394. @item preset
  6395. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6396. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6397. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6398. Available presets are:
  6399. @table @samp
  6400. @item none
  6401. @item color_negative
  6402. @item cross_process
  6403. @item darker
  6404. @item increase_contrast
  6405. @item lighter
  6406. @item linear_contrast
  6407. @item medium_contrast
  6408. @item negative
  6409. @item strong_contrast
  6410. @item vintage
  6411. @end table
  6412. Default is @code{none}.
  6413. @item master, m
  6414. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6415. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6416. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6417. post-processing LUT.
  6418. @item red, r
  6419. Set the key points for the red component.
  6420. @item green, g
  6421. Set the key points for the green component.
  6422. @item blue, b
  6423. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6424. @item all
  6425. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6426. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6427. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6428. @option{all} setting.
  6429. @item psfile
  6430. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6431. @item plot
  6432. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6433. @end table
  6434. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6435. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6436. @subsection Examples
  6437. @itemize
  6438. @item
  6439. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6440. @example
  6441. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6442. @end example
  6443. @item
  6444. Vintage effect:
  6445. @example
  6446. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6447. @end example
  6448. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6449. @table @var
  6450. @item red
  6451. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6452. @item green
  6453. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6454. @item blue
  6455. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6456. @end table
  6457. @item
  6458. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6459. @example
  6460. curves=preset=vintage
  6461. @end example
  6462. @item
  6463. Or simply:
  6464. @example
  6465. curves=vintage
  6466. @end example
  6467. @item
  6468. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6469. @example
  6470. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6471. @end example
  6472. @item
  6473. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6474. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6475. @example
  6476. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6477. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6478. @end example
  6479. @end itemize
  6480. @section datascope
  6481. Video data analysis filter.
  6482. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6483. The filter accepts the following options:
  6484. @table @option
  6485. @item size, s
  6486. Set output video size.
  6487. @item x
  6488. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6489. @item y
  6490. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6491. @item mode
  6492. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6493. @table @samp
  6494. @item mono
  6495. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6496. @item color
  6497. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6498. background.
  6499. @item color2
  6500. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6501. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6502. @end table
  6503. @item axis
  6504. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6505. @item opacity
  6506. Set background opacity.
  6507. @item format
  6508. Set display number format. Can be @code{hex}, or @code{dec}. Default is @code{hex}.
  6509. @end table
  6510. @section dctdnoiz
  6511. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6512. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6513. The filter accepts the following options:
  6514. @table @option
  6515. @item sigma, s
  6516. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6517. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6518. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6519. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6520. Default is @code{0}.
  6521. @item overlap
  6522. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6523. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6524. risk of various artefacts.
  6525. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6526. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6527. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6528. @item expr, e
  6529. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6530. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6531. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6532. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6533. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6534. variable.
  6535. @item n
  6536. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6537. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6538. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6539. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6540. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6541. better de-noising.
  6542. @end table
  6543. @subsection Examples
  6544. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6545. @example
  6546. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6547. @end example
  6548. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6549. @example
  6550. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6551. @end example
  6552. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6553. @example
  6554. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6555. @end example
  6556. @section deband
  6557. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6558. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6559. The filter accepts the following options:
  6560. @table @option
  6561. @item 1thr
  6562. @item 2thr
  6563. @item 3thr
  6564. @item 4thr
  6565. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6566. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6567. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6568. it will be considered as banded.
  6569. @item range, r
  6570. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6571. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6572. will be used.
  6573. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6574. @item direction, d
  6575. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6576. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6577. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6578. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6579. column.
  6580. @item blur, b
  6581. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6582. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6583. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6584. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6585. @item coupling, c
  6586. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6587. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6588. The default is disabled.
  6589. @end table
  6590. @section deblock
  6591. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6592. The filter accepts the following options:
  6593. @table @option
  6594. @item filter
  6595. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6596. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6597. @item block
  6598. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6599. @item alpha
  6600. @item beta
  6601. @item gamma
  6602. @item delta
  6603. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6604. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6605. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6606. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6607. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6608. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6609. deblocking.
  6610. @item planes
  6611. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6612. @end table
  6613. @subsection Examples
  6614. @itemize
  6615. @item
  6616. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6617. @example
  6618. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6619. @end example
  6620. @item
  6621. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6622. deblocking more edges.
  6623. @example
  6624. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6625. @end example
  6626. @item
  6627. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6628. @example
  6629. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6630. @end example
  6631. @item
  6632. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6633. @example
  6634. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6635. @end example
  6636. @end itemize
  6637. @anchor{decimate}
  6638. @section decimate
  6639. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6640. The filter accepts the following options:
  6641. @table @option
  6642. @item cycle
  6643. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6644. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6645. Default is @code{5}.
  6646. @item dupthresh
  6647. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6648. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6649. is @code{1.1}
  6650. @item scthresh
  6651. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6652. @item blockx
  6653. @item blocky
  6654. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6655. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6656. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6657. @item ppsrc
  6658. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6659. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6660. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6661. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6662. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6663. @code{0}.
  6664. @item chroma
  6665. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6666. @code{1}.
  6667. @end table
  6668. @section deconvolve
  6669. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6670. as impulse.
  6671. The filter accepts the following options:
  6672. @table @option
  6673. @item planes
  6674. Set which planes to process.
  6675. @item impulse
  6676. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6677. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6678. @item noise
  6679. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6680. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6681. had noise.
  6682. @end table
  6683. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6684. @section dedot
  6685. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6686. It accepts the following options:
  6687. @table @option
  6688. @item m
  6689. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6690. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6691. @item lt
  6692. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6693. @item tl
  6694. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6695. @item tc
  6696. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6697. @item ct
  6698. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6699. @end table
  6700. @section deflate
  6701. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6702. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6703. only values lower than the pixel.
  6704. It accepts the following options:
  6705. @table @option
  6706. @item threshold0
  6707. @item threshold1
  6708. @item threshold2
  6709. @item threshold3
  6710. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6711. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6712. @end table
  6713. @subsection Commands
  6714. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6715. @section deflicker
  6716. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6717. It accepts the following options:
  6718. @table @option
  6719. @item size, s
  6720. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6721. @item mode, m
  6722. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6723. Available values are:
  6724. @table @samp
  6725. @item am
  6726. Arithmetic mean
  6727. @item gm
  6728. Geometric mean
  6729. @item hm
  6730. Harmonic mean
  6731. @item qm
  6732. Quadratic mean
  6733. @item cm
  6734. Cubic mean
  6735. @item pm
  6736. Power mean
  6737. @item median
  6738. Median
  6739. @end table
  6740. @item bypass
  6741. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6742. @end table
  6743. @section dejudder
  6744. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6745. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6746. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6747. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6748. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6749. rate video.
  6750. The option available in this filter is:
  6751. @table @option
  6752. @item cycle
  6753. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6754. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6755. @table @samp
  6756. @item 4
  6757. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6758. @item 5
  6759. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6760. @item 20
  6761. If a mixture of the two.
  6762. @end table
  6763. The default is @samp{4}.
  6764. @end table
  6765. @section delogo
  6766. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6767. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6768. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6769. It accepts the following parameters:
  6770. @table @option
  6771. @item x
  6772. @item y
  6773. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6774. specified.
  6775. @item w
  6776. @item h
  6777. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6778. specified.
  6779. @item band, t
  6780. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6781. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6782. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6783. is not recommended.
  6784. @item show
  6785. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6786. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6787. The default value is 0.
  6788. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6789. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6790. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6791. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6792. @end table
  6793. @subsection Examples
  6794. @itemize
  6795. @item
  6796. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6797. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6798. @example
  6799. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6800. @end example
  6801. @end itemize
  6802. @section derain
  6803. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6804. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6805. @itemize
  6806. @item
  6807. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6808. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6809. @end itemize
  6810. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6811. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6812. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6813. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6814. The filter accepts the following options:
  6815. @table @option
  6816. @item filter_type
  6817. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6818. @table @samp
  6819. @item derain
  6820. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6821. @item dehaze
  6822. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6823. @end table
  6824. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6825. @item dnn_backend
  6826. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6827. the following values:
  6828. @table @samp
  6829. @item native
  6830. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6831. @item tensorflow
  6832. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6833. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6834. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6835. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6836. @end table
  6837. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6838. @item model
  6839. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6840. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6841. backend can load files for only its format.
  6842. @end table
  6843. @section deshake
  6844. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6845. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6846. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6847. The filter accepts the following options:
  6848. @table @option
  6849. @item x
  6850. @item y
  6851. @item w
  6852. @item h
  6853. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6854. vectors.
  6855. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6856. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6857. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6858. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6859. box.
  6860. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6861. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6862. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6863. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6864. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6865. Default - search the whole frame.
  6866. @item rx
  6867. @item ry
  6868. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6869. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6870. @item edge
  6871. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6872. frame. Available values are:
  6873. @table @samp
  6874. @item blank, 0
  6875. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6876. @item original, 1
  6877. Original image at blank locations
  6878. @item clamp, 2
  6879. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6880. @item mirror, 3
  6881. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6882. @end table
  6883. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6884. @item blocksize
  6885. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6886. default 8.
  6887. @item contrast
  6888. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6889. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6890. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6891. @item search
  6892. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6893. @table @samp
  6894. @item exhaustive, 0
  6895. Set exhaustive search
  6896. @item less, 1
  6897. Set less exhaustive search.
  6898. @end table
  6899. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6900. @item filename
  6901. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6902. specified file.
  6903. @end table
  6904. @section despill
  6905. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  6906. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  6907. This filter accepts the following options:
  6908. @table @option
  6909. @item type
  6910. Set what type of despill to use.
  6911. @item mix
  6912. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  6913. @item expand
  6914. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  6915. @item red
  6916. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  6917. @item green
  6918. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  6919. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  6920. @item blue
  6921. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  6922. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  6923. @item brightness
  6924. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  6925. @item alpha
  6926. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  6927. @end table
  6928. @section detelecine
  6929. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  6930. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  6931. to the telecine filter.
  6932. This filter accepts the following options:
  6933. @table @option
  6934. @item first_field
  6935. @table @samp
  6936. @item top, t
  6937. top field first
  6938. @item bottom, b
  6939. bottom field first
  6940. The default value is @code{top}.
  6941. @end table
  6942. @item pattern
  6943. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  6944. The default value is @code{23}.
  6945. @item start_frame
  6946. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  6947. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  6948. @end table
  6949. @section dilation
  6950. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  6951. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  6952. It accepts the following options:
  6953. @table @option
  6954. @item threshold0
  6955. @item threshold1
  6956. @item threshold2
  6957. @item threshold3
  6958. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6959. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6960. @item coordinates
  6961. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  6962. pixels are used.
  6963. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  6964. 1 2 3
  6965. 4 5
  6966. 6 7 8
  6967. @end table
  6968. @subsection Commands
  6969. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6970. @section displace
  6971. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  6972. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  6973. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  6974. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  6975. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  6976. along the y-axis.
  6977. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  6978. displacement map will be used.
  6979. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  6980. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6981. @table @option
  6982. @item edge
  6983. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  6984. Available values are:
  6985. @table @samp
  6986. @item blank
  6987. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  6988. @item smear
  6989. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  6990. @item wrap
  6991. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  6992. @item mirror
  6993. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  6994. @end table
  6995. Default is @samp{smear}.
  6996. @end table
  6997. @subsection Examples
  6998. @itemize
  6999. @item
  7000. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7001. @example
  7002. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  7003. @end example
  7004. @item
  7005. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7006. @example
  7007. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  7008. @end example
  7009. @end itemize
  7010. @section dnn_processing
  7011. Do image processing with deep neural networks. It works together with another filter
  7012. which converts the pixel format of the Frame to what the dnn network requires.
  7013. The filter accepts the following options:
  7014. @table @option
  7015. @item dnn_backend
  7016. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  7017. the following values:
  7018. @table @samp
  7019. @item native
  7020. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  7021. @item tensorflow
  7022. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  7023. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  7024. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  7025. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  7026. @end table
  7027. Default value is @samp{native}.
  7028. @item model
  7029. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  7030. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  7031. backend can load files for only its format.
  7032. Native model file (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model file (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  7033. @item input
  7034. Set the input name of the dnn network.
  7035. @item output
  7036. Set the output name of the dnn network.
  7037. @end table
  7038. @itemize
  7039. @item
  7040. Halve the red channle of the frame with format rgb24:
  7041. @example
  7042. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=rgb24,dnn_processing=model=halve_first_channel.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native out.native.png
  7043. @end example
  7044. @item
  7045. Halve the pixel value of the frame with format gray32f:
  7046. @example
  7047. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=grayf32,dnn_processing=model=halve_gray_float.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native -y out.native.png
  7048. @end example
  7049. @end itemize
  7050. @section drawbox
  7051. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  7052. It accepts the following parameters:
  7053. @table @option
  7054. @item x
  7055. @item y
  7056. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  7057. @item width, w
  7058. @item height, h
  7059. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  7060. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  7061. @item color, c
  7062. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  7063. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7064. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  7065. video with inverted luma.
  7066. @item thickness, t
  7067. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  7068. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  7069. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7070. @item replace
  7071. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  7072. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7073. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7074. @end table
  7075. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7076. following constants:
  7077. @table @option
  7078. @item dar
  7079. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7080. @item hsub
  7081. @item vsub
  7082. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7083. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7084. @item in_h, ih
  7085. @item in_w, iw
  7086. The input width and height.
  7087. @item sar
  7088. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7089. @item x
  7090. @item y
  7091. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  7092. @item w
  7093. @item h
  7094. The width and height of the drawn box.
  7095. @item t
  7096. The thickness of the drawn box.
  7097. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7098. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7099. @end table
  7100. @subsection Examples
  7101. @itemize
  7102. @item
  7103. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  7104. @example
  7105. drawbox
  7106. @end example
  7107. @item
  7108. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7109. @example
  7110. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  7111. @end example
  7112. The previous example can be specified as:
  7113. @example
  7114. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  7115. @end example
  7116. @item
  7117. Fill the box with pink color:
  7118. @example
  7119. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  7120. @end example
  7121. @item
  7122. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  7123. @example
  7124. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  7125. @end example
  7126. @end itemize
  7127. @subsection Commands
  7128. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7129. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7130. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7131. value.
  7132. @anchor{drawgraph}
  7133. @section drawgraph
  7134. Draw a graph using input video metadata.
  7135. It accepts the following parameters:
  7136. @table @option
  7137. @item m1
  7138. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7139. @item fg1
  7140. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  7141. @item m2
  7142. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7143. @item fg2
  7144. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  7145. @item m3
  7146. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7147. @item fg3
  7148. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  7149. @item m4
  7150. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7151. @item fg4
  7152. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  7153. @item min
  7154. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  7155. @item max
  7156. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  7157. @item bg
  7158. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  7159. @item mode
  7160. Set graph mode.
  7161. Available values for mode is:
  7162. @table @samp
  7163. @item bar
  7164. @item dot
  7165. @item line
  7166. @end table
  7167. Default is @code{line}.
  7168. @item slide
  7169. Set slide mode.
  7170. Available values for slide is:
  7171. @table @samp
  7172. @item frame
  7173. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  7174. @item replace
  7175. Replace old columns with new ones.
  7176. @item scroll
  7177. Scroll from right to left.
  7178. @item rscroll
  7179. Scroll from left to right.
  7180. @item picture
  7181. Draw single picture.
  7182. @end table
  7183. Default is @code{frame}.
  7184. @item size
  7185. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  7186. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7187. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  7188. @item rate, r
  7189. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  7190. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  7191. @table @option
  7192. @item MIN
  7193. Minimal value of metadata value.
  7194. @item MAX
  7195. Maximal value of metadata value.
  7196. @item VAL
  7197. Current metadata key value.
  7198. @end table
  7199. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  7200. @end table
  7201. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  7202. @example
  7203. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  7204. @end example
  7205. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  7206. @example
  7207. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  7208. @end example
  7209. @section drawgrid
  7210. Draw a grid on the input image.
  7211. It accepts the following parameters:
  7212. @table @option
  7213. @item x
  7214. @item y
  7215. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  7216. @item width, w
  7217. @item height, h
  7218. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  7219. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  7220. framed. Default to 0.
  7221. @item color, c
  7222. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  7223. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7224. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  7225. video with inverted luma.
  7226. @item thickness, t
  7227. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  7228. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7229. @item replace
  7230. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  7231. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7232. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7233. @end table
  7234. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7235. following constants:
  7236. @table @option
  7237. @item dar
  7238. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7239. @item hsub
  7240. @item vsub
  7241. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7242. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7243. @item in_h, ih
  7244. @item in_w, iw
  7245. The input grid cell width and height.
  7246. @item sar
  7247. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7248. @item x
  7249. @item y
  7250. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  7251. @item w
  7252. @item h
  7253. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  7254. @item t
  7255. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  7256. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7257. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7258. @end table
  7259. @subsection Examples
  7260. @itemize
  7261. @item
  7262. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7263. @example
  7264. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  7265. @end example
  7266. @item
  7267. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  7268. @example
  7269. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  7270. @end example
  7271. @end itemize
  7272. @subsection Commands
  7273. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7274. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7275. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7276. value.
  7277. @anchor{drawtext}
  7278. @section drawtext
  7279. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  7280. libfreetype library.
  7281. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7282. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  7283. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  7284. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  7285. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7286. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  7287. @subsection Syntax
  7288. It accepts the following parameters:
  7289. @table @option
  7290. @item box
  7291. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7292. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7293. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7294. @item boxborderw
  7295. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7296. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7297. @item boxcolor
  7298. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7299. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7300. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7301. @item line_spacing
  7302. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7303. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7304. @item borderw
  7305. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7306. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7307. @item bordercolor
  7308. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7309. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7310. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7311. @item expansion
  7312. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7313. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7314. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7315. below for details.
  7316. @item basetime
  7317. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7318. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7319. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7320. as the second argument.
  7321. @item fix_bounds
  7322. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7323. @item fontcolor
  7324. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7325. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7326. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7327. @item fontcolor_expr
  7328. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7329. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7330. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7331. @item font
  7332. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7333. @item fontfile
  7334. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7335. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7336. @item alpha
  7337. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7338. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7339. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7340. The default value is 1.
  7341. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7342. @item fontsize
  7343. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7344. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7345. @item text_shaping
  7346. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7347. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7348. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7349. By default 1 (if supported).
  7350. @item ft_load_flags
  7351. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7352. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7353. a combination of the following values:
  7354. @table @var
  7355. @item default
  7356. @item no_scale
  7357. @item no_hinting
  7358. @item render
  7359. @item no_bitmap
  7360. @item vertical_layout
  7361. @item force_autohint
  7362. @item crop_bitmap
  7363. @item pedantic
  7364. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7365. @item no_recurse
  7366. @item ignore_transform
  7367. @item monochrome
  7368. @item linear_design
  7369. @item no_autohint
  7370. @end table
  7371. Default value is "default".
  7372. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7373. libfreetype flags.
  7374. @item shadowcolor
  7375. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7376. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7377. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7378. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7379. @item shadowx
  7380. @item shadowy
  7381. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7382. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7383. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7384. @item start_number
  7385. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7386. is "0".
  7387. @item tabsize
  7388. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7389. Default value is 4.
  7390. @item timecode
  7391. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7392. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7393. option must be specified.
  7394. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7395. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7396. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7397. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7398. @item tc24hmax
  7399. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7400. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7401. @item text
  7402. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7403. encoded characters.
  7404. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7405. @var{textfile}.
  7406. @item textfile
  7407. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7408. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7409. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7410. parameter @var{text}.
  7411. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7412. @item reload
  7413. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7414. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7415. @item x
  7416. @item y
  7417. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7418. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7419. output image.
  7420. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7421. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7422. @end table
  7423. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7424. following constants and functions:
  7425. @table @option
  7426. @item dar
  7427. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7428. @item hsub
  7429. @item vsub
  7430. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7431. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7432. @item line_h, lh
  7433. the height of each text line
  7434. @item main_h, h, H
  7435. the input height
  7436. @item main_w, w, W
  7437. the input width
  7438. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7439. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7440. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7441. glyphs.
  7442. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7443. upwards.
  7444. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7445. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7446. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7447. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7448. upwards.
  7449. @item max_glyph_h
  7450. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7451. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7452. @var{descent}.
  7453. @item max_glyph_w
  7454. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7455. contained in the rendered text
  7456. @item n
  7457. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7458. @item rand(min, max)
  7459. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7460. @item sar
  7461. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7462. @item t
  7463. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7464. @item text_h, th
  7465. the height of the rendered text
  7466. @item text_w, tw
  7467. the width of the rendered text
  7468. @item x
  7469. @item y
  7470. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7471. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7472. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7473. @item pict_type
  7474. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7475. @item pkt_pos
  7476. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7477. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7478. this info is not available.
  7479. @item pkt_duration
  7480. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7481. @item pkt_size
  7482. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7483. @end table
  7484. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7485. @subsection Text expansion
  7486. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7487. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7488. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7489. feature is deprecated.
  7490. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7491. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7492. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7493. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7494. the second character.
  7495. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7496. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7497. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7498. they should be escaped.
  7499. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7500. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7501. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7502. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7503. problems.
  7504. The following functions are available:
  7505. @table @command
  7506. @item expr, e
  7507. The expression evaluation result.
  7508. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7509. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7510. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7511. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7512. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7513. value.
  7514. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7515. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7516. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7517. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7518. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7519. @code{printf} function.
  7520. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7521. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7522. @item gmtime
  7523. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7524. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7525. @item localtime
  7526. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7527. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7528. @item metadata
  7529. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7530. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7531. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7532. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7533. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7534. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7535. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7536. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7537. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7538. @item n, frame_num
  7539. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7540. @item pict_type
  7541. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7542. @item pts
  7543. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7544. It can take up to three arguments.
  7545. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7546. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7547. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7548. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7549. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7550. local time zone time.
  7551. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7552. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7553. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7554. (00-23).
  7555. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7556. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7557. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7558. @end table
  7559. @subsection Commands
  7560. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7561. @table @option
  7562. @item reinit
  7563. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7564. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7565. @example
  7566. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7567. @end example
  7568. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7569. @example
  7570. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7571. @end example
  7572. @end table
  7573. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7574. continue with its existing parameters.
  7575. @subsection Examples
  7576. @itemize
  7577. @item
  7578. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7579. optional parameters.
  7580. @example
  7581. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7582. @end example
  7583. @item
  7584. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7585. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7586. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7587. opacity of 20%.
  7588. @example
  7589. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7590. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7591. @end example
  7592. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7593. within the parameter list.
  7594. @item
  7595. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7596. @example
  7597. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7598. @end example
  7599. @item
  7600. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7601. @example
  7602. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7603. @end example
  7604. @item
  7605. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7606. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7607. with no newlines.
  7608. @example
  7609. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7610. @end example
  7611. @item
  7612. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7613. @example
  7614. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7615. @end example
  7616. @item
  7617. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7618. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7619. @example
  7620. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7621. @end example
  7622. @item
  7623. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7624. @example
  7625. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7626. @end example
  7627. @item
  7628. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7629. @example
  7630. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7631. @end example
  7632. @item
  7633. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7634. @example
  7635. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7636. @end example
  7637. @item
  7638. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7639. @example
  7640. #!/bin/sh
  7641. DS=1.0 # display start
  7642. DE=10.0 # display end
  7643. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7644. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7645. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7646. @end example
  7647. @item
  7648. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7649. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7650. @example
  7651. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7652. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7653. @end example
  7654. @item
  7655. Plot special @var{lavf.image2dec.source_basename} metadata onto each frame if
  7656. such metadata exists. Otherwise, plot the string "NA". Note that image2 demuxer
  7657. must have option @option{-export_path_metadata 1} for the special metadata fields
  7658. to be available for filters.
  7659. @example
  7660. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontcolor=white:fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text='%@{metadata\:lavf.image2dec.source_basename\:NA@}':x=10:y=10"
  7661. @end example
  7662. @end itemize
  7663. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7664. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7665. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7666. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7667. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7668. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7669. @section edgedetect
  7670. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7671. The filter accepts the following options:
  7672. @table @option
  7673. @item low
  7674. @item high
  7675. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7676. algorithm.
  7677. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7678. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7679. by the low threshold.
  7680. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7681. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7682. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7683. is @code{50/255}.
  7684. @item mode
  7685. Define the drawing mode.
  7686. @table @samp
  7687. @item wires
  7688. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7689. @item colormix
  7690. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7691. @item canny
  7692. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7693. @end table
  7694. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7695. @item planes
  7696. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7697. @end table
  7698. @subsection Examples
  7699. @itemize
  7700. @item
  7701. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7702. @example
  7703. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7704. @end example
  7705. @item
  7706. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7707. @example
  7708. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7709. @end example
  7710. @end itemize
  7711. @section elbg
  7712. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7713. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7714. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7715. of distinct output colors.
  7716. This filter accepts the following options.
  7717. @table @option
  7718. @item codebook_length, l
  7719. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7720. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7721. @item nb_steps, n
  7722. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7723. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7724. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7725. @item seed, s
  7726. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7727. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7728. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7729. @item pal8
  7730. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7731. length greater than 256.
  7732. @end table
  7733. @section entropy
  7734. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7735. It accepts the following parameters:
  7736. @table @option
  7737. @item mode
  7738. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7739. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7740. between neighbour histogram values.
  7741. @end table
  7742. @section eq
  7743. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7744. The filter accepts the following options:
  7745. @table @option
  7746. @item contrast
  7747. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7748. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7749. @item brightness
  7750. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7751. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7752. @item saturation
  7753. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7754. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7755. @item gamma
  7756. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7757. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7758. @item gamma_r
  7759. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7760. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7761. @item gamma_g
  7762. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7763. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7764. @item gamma_b
  7765. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7766. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7767. @item gamma_weight
  7768. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7769. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7770. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7771. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7772. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7773. full strength. Default is "1".
  7774. @item eval
  7775. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7776. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7777. It accepts the following values:
  7778. @table @samp
  7779. @item init
  7780. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7781. when a command is processed
  7782. @item frame
  7783. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7784. @end table
  7785. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7786. @end table
  7787. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7788. @table @option
  7789. @item n
  7790. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7791. @item pos
  7792. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7793. unspecified
  7794. @item r
  7795. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7796. @item t
  7797. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7798. @end table
  7799. @subsection Commands
  7800. The filter supports the following commands:
  7801. @table @option
  7802. @item contrast
  7803. Set the contrast expression.
  7804. @item brightness
  7805. Set the brightness expression.
  7806. @item saturation
  7807. Set the saturation expression.
  7808. @item gamma
  7809. Set the gamma expression.
  7810. @item gamma_r
  7811. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7812. @item gamma_g
  7813. Set gamma_g expression.
  7814. @item gamma_b
  7815. Set gamma_b expression.
  7816. @item gamma_weight
  7817. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7818. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7819. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7820. value.
  7821. @end table
  7822. @section erosion
  7823. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7824. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7825. It accepts the following options:
  7826. @table @option
  7827. @item threshold0
  7828. @item threshold1
  7829. @item threshold2
  7830. @item threshold3
  7831. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7832. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7833. @item coordinates
  7834. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7835. pixels are used.
  7836. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7837. 1 2 3
  7838. 4 5
  7839. 6 7 8
  7840. @end table
  7841. @subsection Commands
  7842. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7843. @section extractplanes
  7844. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7845. separate grayscale video streams.
  7846. The filter accepts the following option:
  7847. @table @option
  7848. @item planes
  7849. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7850. Available values for planes are:
  7851. @table @samp
  7852. @item y
  7853. @item u
  7854. @item v
  7855. @item a
  7856. @item r
  7857. @item g
  7858. @item b
  7859. @end table
  7860. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7861. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7862. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7863. @end table
  7864. @subsection Examples
  7865. @itemize
  7866. @item
  7867. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7868. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7869. @example
  7870. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7871. @end example
  7872. @end itemize
  7873. @section fade
  7874. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7875. It accepts the following parameters:
  7876. @table @option
  7877. @item type, t
  7878. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7879. effect.
  7880. Default is @code{in}.
  7881. @item start_frame, s
  7882. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7883. effect at. Default is 0.
  7884. @item nb_frames, n
  7885. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7886. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7887. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7888. selected @option{color}.
  7889. Default is 25.
  7890. @item alpha
  7891. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7892. Default value is 0.
  7893. @item start_time, st
  7894. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  7895. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  7896. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  7897. @item duration, d
  7898. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  7899. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  7900. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  7901. selected @option{color}.
  7902. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  7903. (nb_frames is used by default).
  7904. @item color, c
  7905. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  7906. @end table
  7907. @subsection Examples
  7908. @itemize
  7909. @item
  7910. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  7911. @example
  7912. fade=in:0:30
  7913. @end example
  7914. The command above is equivalent to:
  7915. @example
  7916. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  7917. @end example
  7918. @item
  7919. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  7920. @example
  7921. fade=out:155:45
  7922. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  7923. @end example
  7924. @item
  7925. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  7926. @example
  7927. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  7928. @end example
  7929. @item
  7930. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  7931. @example
  7932. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  7933. @end example
  7934. @item
  7935. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  7936. @example
  7937. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  7938. @end example
  7939. @item
  7940. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  7941. @example
  7942. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  7943. @end example
  7944. @end itemize
  7945. @section fftdnoiz
  7946. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  7947. The filter accepts the following options:
  7948. @table @option
  7949. @item sigma
  7950. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  7951. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  7952. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  7953. @item amount
  7954. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  7955. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  7956. @item block
  7957. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  7958. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  7959. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  7960. @item overlap
  7961. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  7962. @item prev
  7963. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7964. @item next
  7965. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7966. @item planes
  7967. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  7968. except alpha.
  7969. @end table
  7970. @section fftfilt
  7971. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  7972. @table @option
  7973. @item dc_Y
  7974. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  7975. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  7976. value is set to @code{0}.
  7977. @item dc_U
  7978. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  7979. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7980. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7981. @item dc_V
  7982. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  7983. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7984. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7985. @item weight_Y
  7986. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  7987. @item weight_U
  7988. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  7989. @item weight_V
  7990. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  7991. @item eval
  7992. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  7993. It accepts the following values:
  7994. @table @samp
  7995. @item init
  7996. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  7997. @item frame
  7998. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  7999. @end table
  8000. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8001. The filter accepts the following variables:
  8002. @item X
  8003. @item Y
  8004. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8005. @item W
  8006. @item H
  8007. The width and height of the image.
  8008. @item N
  8009. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  8010. @end table
  8011. @subsection Examples
  8012. @itemize
  8013. @item
  8014. High-pass:
  8015. @example
  8016. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8017. @end example
  8018. @item
  8019. Low-pass:
  8020. @example
  8021. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  8022. @end example
  8023. @item
  8024. Sharpen:
  8025. @example
  8026. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8027. @end example
  8028. @item
  8029. Blur:
  8030. @example
  8031. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  8032. @end example
  8033. @end itemize
  8034. @section field
  8035. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  8036. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  8037. non-interlaced.
  8038. The filter accepts the following options:
  8039. @table @option
  8040. @item type
  8041. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  8042. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  8043. @code{bottom}).
  8044. @end table
  8045. @section fieldhint
  8046. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  8047. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  8048. @table @option
  8049. @item hint
  8050. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  8051. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  8052. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  8053. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  8054. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  8055. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  8056. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  8057. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  8058. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  8059. it will be marked same as input frame.
  8060. If optionally followed by @code{t} output frame will use only top field, or in
  8061. case of @code{b} it will use only bottom field.
  8062. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  8063. @item mode
  8064. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  8065. @end table
  8066. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  8067. @example
  8068. 0,0 - # first frame
  8069. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  8070. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  8071. 1,0 -
  8072. 0,0 -
  8073. 0,0 -
  8074. 1,0 -
  8075. 1,0 -
  8076. 1,0 -
  8077. 0,0 -
  8078. 0,0 -
  8079. 1,0 -
  8080. 1,0 -
  8081. 1,0 -
  8082. 0,0 -
  8083. @end example
  8084. @section fieldmatch
  8085. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  8086. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  8087. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  8088. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  8089. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  8090. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  8091. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  8092. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  8093. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  8094. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  8095. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  8096. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  8097. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  8098. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  8099. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  8100. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  8101. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  8102. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  8103. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  8104. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  8105. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  8106. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  8107. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  8108. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  8109. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  8110. The filter accepts the following options:
  8111. @table @option
  8112. @item order
  8113. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  8114. @table @samp
  8115. @item auto
  8116. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  8117. @item bff
  8118. Assume bottom field first.
  8119. @item tff
  8120. Assume top field first.
  8121. @end table
  8122. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  8123. stream.
  8124. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8125. @item mode
  8126. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  8127. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  8128. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  8129. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  8130. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  8131. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  8132. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  8133. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  8134. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  8135. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  8136. Available values are:
  8137. @table @samp
  8138. @item pc
  8139. 2-way matching (p/c)
  8140. @item pc_n
  8141. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  8142. @item pc_u
  8143. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  8144. @item pc_n_ub
  8145. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  8146. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  8147. @item pcn
  8148. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  8149. @item pcn_ub
  8150. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  8151. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  8152. @end table
  8153. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  8154. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  8155. @var{top}).
  8156. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  8157. the slowest.
  8158. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  8159. @item ppsrc
  8160. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  8161. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  8162. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  8163. VFM/TFM.
  8164. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  8165. @item field
  8166. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  8167. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  8168. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  8169. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  8170. @table @samp
  8171. @item auto
  8172. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  8173. @item bottom
  8174. Match from the bottom field.
  8175. @item top
  8176. Match from the top field.
  8177. @end table
  8178. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8179. @item mchroma
  8180. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  8181. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  8182. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  8183. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  8184. the cost of some accuracy.
  8185. Default value is @code{1}.
  8186. @item y0
  8187. @item y1
  8188. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  8189. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  8190. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  8191. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  8192. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  8193. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  8194. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  8195. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  8196. @item scthresh
  8197. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  8198. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  8199. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  8200. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  8201. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  8202. @item combmatch
  8203. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  8204. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  8205. final match. Available values are:
  8206. @table @samp
  8207. @item none
  8208. No final matching based on combed scores.
  8209. @item sc
  8210. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  8211. @item full
  8212. Use combed scores all the time.
  8213. @end table
  8214. Default is @var{sc}.
  8215. @item combdbg
  8216. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  8217. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8218. Available values are:
  8219. @table @samp
  8220. @item none
  8221. No forced calculation.
  8222. @item pcn
  8223. Force p/c/n calculations.
  8224. @item pcnub
  8225. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  8226. @end table
  8227. Default value is @var{none}.
  8228. @item cthresh
  8229. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  8230. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  8231. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  8232. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  8233. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  8234. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  8235. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  8236. Default value is @code{9}.
  8237. @item chroma
  8238. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  8239. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  8240. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  8241. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  8242. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  8243. Default value is @code{0}.
  8244. @item blockx
  8245. @item blocky
  8246. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  8247. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  8248. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  8249. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  8250. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  8251. to 512.
  8252. Default value is @code{16}.
  8253. @item combpel
  8254. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  8255. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  8256. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  8257. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  8258. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  8259. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  8260. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  8261. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8262. Default value is @code{80}.
  8263. @end table
  8264. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  8265. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  8266. @subsubsection p/c/n
  8267. We assume the following telecined stream:
  8268. @example
  8269. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  8270. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  8271. @end example
  8272. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  8273. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  8274. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  8275. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  8276. @example
  8277. Input stream:
  8278. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8279. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  8280. Matches: c c n n c
  8281. Output stream:
  8282. T 1 2 3 4 4
  8283. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8284. @end example
  8285. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  8286. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  8287. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  8288. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  8289. looks like this:
  8290. @example
  8291. Input stream:
  8292. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  8293. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8294. Matches: c c p p c
  8295. Output stream:
  8296. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8297. B 1 2 2 3 4
  8298. @end example
  8299. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  8300. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  8301. @itemize
  8302. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8303. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8304. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8305. @end itemize
  8306. @subsubsection u/b
  8307. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8308. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8309. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8310. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8311. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8312. @example
  8313. Match: c p n b u
  8314. x x x x x
  8315. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8316. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8317. x x x x x
  8318. Output frames:
  8319. 2 1 2 2 2
  8320. 2 2 2 1 3
  8321. @end example
  8322. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8323. @example
  8324. Match: c p n b u
  8325. x x x x x
  8326. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8327. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8328. x x x x x
  8329. Output frames:
  8330. 2 2 2 1 2
  8331. 2 1 3 2 2
  8332. @end example
  8333. @subsection Examples
  8334. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8335. @example
  8336. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8337. @end example
  8338. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8339. @example
  8340. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8341. @end example
  8342. @section fieldorder
  8343. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8344. It accepts the following parameters:
  8345. @table @option
  8346. @item order
  8347. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8348. for bottom field first.
  8349. @end table
  8350. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8351. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8352. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8353. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8354. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8355. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8356. not alter the incoming video.
  8357. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8358. which is bottom field first.
  8359. For example:
  8360. @example
  8361. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8362. @end example
  8363. @section fifo, afifo
  8364. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8365. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8366. framework.
  8367. It does not take parameters.
  8368. @section fillborders
  8369. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8370. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8371. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8372. This filter accepts the following options:
  8373. @table @option
  8374. @item left
  8375. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8376. @item right
  8377. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8378. @item top
  8379. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8380. @item bottom
  8381. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8382. @item mode
  8383. Set fill mode.
  8384. It accepts the following values:
  8385. @table @samp
  8386. @item smear
  8387. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8388. @item mirror
  8389. fill pixels using mirroring
  8390. @item fixed
  8391. fill pixels with constant value
  8392. @end table
  8393. Default is @var{smear}.
  8394. @item color
  8395. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8396. @end table
  8397. @subsection Commands
  8398. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  8399. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8400. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8401. value.
  8402. @section find_rect
  8403. Find a rectangular object
  8404. It accepts the following options:
  8405. @table @option
  8406. @item object
  8407. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8408. @item threshold
  8409. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8410. @item mipmaps
  8411. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8412. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8413. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8414. @end table
  8415. @subsection Examples
  8416. @itemize
  8417. @item
  8418. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8419. @example
  8420. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8421. @end example
  8422. @end itemize
  8423. @section floodfill
  8424. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8425. It accepts the following options:
  8426. @table @option
  8427. @item x
  8428. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8429. @item y
  8430. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8431. @item s0
  8432. Set source #0 component value.
  8433. @item s1
  8434. Set source #1 component value.
  8435. @item s2
  8436. Set source #2 component value.
  8437. @item s3
  8438. Set source #3 component value.
  8439. @item d0
  8440. Set destination #0 component value.
  8441. @item d1
  8442. Set destination #1 component value.
  8443. @item d2
  8444. Set destination #2 component value.
  8445. @item d3
  8446. Set destination #3 component value.
  8447. @end table
  8448. @anchor{format}
  8449. @section format
  8450. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8451. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8452. the next filter.
  8453. It accepts the following parameters:
  8454. @table @option
  8455. @item pix_fmts
  8456. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8457. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8458. @end table
  8459. @subsection Examples
  8460. @itemize
  8461. @item
  8462. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8463. @example
  8464. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8465. @end example
  8466. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8467. @example
  8468. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8469. @end example
  8470. @end itemize
  8471. @anchor{fps}
  8472. @section fps
  8473. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8474. frames as necessary.
  8475. It accepts the following parameters:
  8476. @table @option
  8477. @item fps
  8478. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8479. @item start_time
  8480. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8481. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8482. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8483. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8484. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8485. frames with a negative PTS.
  8486. @item round
  8487. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8488. Possible values are:
  8489. @table @option
  8490. @item zero
  8491. round towards 0
  8492. @item inf
  8493. round away from 0
  8494. @item down
  8495. round towards -infinity
  8496. @item up
  8497. round towards +infinity
  8498. @item near
  8499. round to nearest
  8500. @end table
  8501. The default is @code{near}.
  8502. @item eof_action
  8503. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8504. Possible values are:
  8505. @table @option
  8506. @item round
  8507. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8508. @item pass
  8509. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8510. @end table
  8511. The default is @code{round}.
  8512. @end table
  8513. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8514. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8515. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8516. @subsection Examples
  8517. @itemize
  8518. @item
  8519. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8520. @example
  8521. fps=fps=25
  8522. @end example
  8523. @item
  8524. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8525. @example
  8526. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8527. @end example
  8528. @end itemize
  8529. @section framepack
  8530. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8531. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8532. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8533. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8534. @ref{fps} filters.
  8535. It accepts the following parameters:
  8536. @table @option
  8537. @item format
  8538. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8539. @table @option
  8540. @item sbs
  8541. The views are next to each other (default).
  8542. @item tab
  8543. The views are on top of each other.
  8544. @item lines
  8545. The views are packed by line.
  8546. @item columns
  8547. The views are packed by column.
  8548. @item frameseq
  8549. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8550. @end table
  8551. @end table
  8552. Some examples:
  8553. @example
  8554. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8555. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8556. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8557. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8558. @end example
  8559. @section framerate
  8560. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8561. frames.
  8562. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8563. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8564. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8565. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8566. @table @option
  8567. @item fps
  8568. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8569. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8570. @item interp_start
  8571. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8572. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8573. the default is @code{15}.
  8574. @item interp_end
  8575. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8576. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8577. the default is @code{240}.
  8578. @item scene
  8579. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8580. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8581. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8582. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8583. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8584. @item flags
  8585. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8586. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8587. @table @option
  8588. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8589. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8590. This flag is enabled by default.
  8591. @end table
  8592. @end table
  8593. @section framestep
  8594. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8595. This filter accepts the following option:
  8596. @table @option
  8597. @item step
  8598. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8599. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8600. @end table
  8601. @section freezedetect
  8602. Detect frozen video.
  8603. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8604. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8605. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8606. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8607. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8608. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8609. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8610. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8611. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8612. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8613. after the freeze.
  8614. The filter accepts the following options:
  8615. @table @option
  8616. @item noise, n
  8617. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8618. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8619. 0.001.
  8620. @item duration, d
  8621. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8622. @end table
  8623. @section freezeframes
  8624. Freeze video frames.
  8625. This filter freezes video frames using frame from 2nd input.
  8626. The filter accepts the following options:
  8627. @table @option
  8628. @item first
  8629. Set number of first frame from which to start freeze.
  8630. @item last
  8631. Set number of last frame from which to end freeze.
  8632. @item replace
  8633. Set number of frame from 2nd input which will be used instead of replaced frames.
  8634. @end table
  8635. @anchor{frei0r}
  8636. @section frei0r
  8637. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8638. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8639. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8640. It accepts the following parameters:
  8641. @table @option
  8642. @item filter_name
  8643. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8644. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8645. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8646. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8647. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8648. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8649. @item filter_params
  8650. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8651. @end table
  8652. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8653. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8654. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8655. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8656. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8657. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8658. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8659. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8660. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8661. @subsection Examples
  8662. @itemize
  8663. @item
  8664. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8665. @example
  8666. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8667. @end example
  8668. @item
  8669. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8670. @example
  8671. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8672. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8673. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8674. @end example
  8675. @item
  8676. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8677. positions:
  8678. @example
  8679. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8680. @end example
  8681. @end itemize
  8682. For more information, see
  8683. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8684. @section fspp
  8685. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8686. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8687. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8688. This allows for much higher speed.
  8689. The filter accepts the following options:
  8690. @table @option
  8691. @item quality
  8692. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8693. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8694. @item qp
  8695. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8696. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8697. @item strength
  8698. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8699. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8700. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8701. @item use_bframe_qp
  8702. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8703. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8704. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8705. @end table
  8706. @section gblur
  8707. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8708. The filter accepts the following options:
  8709. @table @option
  8710. @item sigma
  8711. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8712. @item steps
  8713. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8714. @item planes
  8715. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8716. @item sigmaV
  8717. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8718. Default is @code{-1}.
  8719. @end table
  8720. @subsection Commands
  8721. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8722. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8723. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8724. value.
  8725. @section geq
  8726. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8727. The filter accepts the following options:
  8728. @table @option
  8729. @item lum_expr, lum
  8730. Set the luminance expression.
  8731. @item cb_expr, cb
  8732. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8733. @item cr_expr, cr
  8734. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8735. @item alpha_expr, a
  8736. Set the alpha expression.
  8737. @item red_expr, r
  8738. Set the red expression.
  8739. @item green_expr, g
  8740. Set the green expression.
  8741. @item blue_expr, b
  8742. Set the blue expression.
  8743. @end table
  8744. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8745. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8746. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8747. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8748. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8749. colorspace.
  8750. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8751. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8752. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8753. to the luminance expression.
  8754. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8755. @table @option
  8756. @item N
  8757. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8758. @item X
  8759. @item Y
  8760. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8761. @item W
  8762. @item H
  8763. The width and height of the image.
  8764. @item SW
  8765. @item SH
  8766. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8767. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8768. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8769. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8770. @item T
  8771. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8772. @item p(x, y)
  8773. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8774. plane.
  8775. @item lum(x, y)
  8776. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8777. plane.
  8778. @item cb(x, y)
  8779. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8780. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8781. @item cr(x, y)
  8782. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8783. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8784. @item r(x, y)
  8785. @item g(x, y)
  8786. @item b(x, y)
  8787. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8788. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8789. @item alpha(x, y)
  8790. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8791. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8792. @item psum(x,y), lumsum(x, y), cbsum(x,y), crsum(x,y), rsum(x,y), gsum(x,y), bsum(x,y), alphasum(x,y)
  8793. Sum of sample values in the rectangle from (0,0) to (x,y), this allows obtaining
  8794. sums of samples within a rectangle. See the functions without the sum postfix.
  8795. @item interpolation
  8796. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8797. @table @option
  8798. @item nearest, n
  8799. @item bilinear, b
  8800. @end table
  8801. Default is bilinear.
  8802. @end table
  8803. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8804. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8805. Please note that this filter can use multiple threads in which case each slice
  8806. will have its own expression state. If you want to use only a single expression
  8807. state because your expressions depend on previous state then you should limit
  8808. the number of filter threads to 1.
  8809. @subsection Examples
  8810. @itemize
  8811. @item
  8812. Flip the image horizontally:
  8813. @example
  8814. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8815. @end example
  8816. @item
  8817. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8818. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8819. @example
  8820. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8821. @end example
  8822. @item
  8823. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8824. @example
  8825. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8826. @end example
  8827. @item
  8828. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8829. @example
  8830. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8831. @end example
  8832. @item
  8833. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8834. @example
  8835. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8836. @end example
  8837. @item
  8838. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8839. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8840. @example
  8841. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8842. @end example
  8843. @end itemize
  8844. @section gradfun
  8845. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8846. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8847. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8848. dither them.
  8849. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8850. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8851. bring back the bands.
  8852. It accepts the following parameters:
  8853. @table @option
  8854. @item strength
  8855. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8856. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8857. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8858. valid range.
  8859. @item radius
  8860. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8861. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8862. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8863. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8864. @end table
  8865. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8866. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8867. @subsection Examples
  8868. @itemize
  8869. @item
  8870. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8871. @example
  8872. gradfun=3.5:8
  8873. @end example
  8874. @item
  8875. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8876. value):
  8877. @example
  8878. gradfun=radius=8
  8879. @end example
  8880. @end itemize
  8881. @anchor{graphmonitor}
  8882. @section graphmonitor
  8883. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8884. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8885. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8886. The filter accepts the following options:
  8887. @table @option
  8888. @item size, s
  8889. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8890. @item opacity, o
  8891. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8892. @item mode, m
  8893. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  8894. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  8895. @item flags, f
  8896. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  8897. Available values for flags are:
  8898. @table @samp
  8899. @item queue
  8900. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  8901. @item frame_count_in
  8902. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  8903. @item frame_count_out
  8904. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  8905. @item pts
  8906. Display current filtered frame pts.
  8907. @item time
  8908. Display current filtered frame time.
  8909. @item timebase
  8910. Display time base for filter link.
  8911. @item format
  8912. Display used format for filter link.
  8913. @item size
  8914. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  8915. @item rate
  8916. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  8917. @end table
  8918. @item rate, r
  8919. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  8920. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  8921. @end table
  8922. @section greyedge
  8923. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  8924. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  8925. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  8926. The filter accepts the following options:
  8927. @table @option
  8928. @item difford
  8929. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  8930. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  8931. @item minknorm
  8932. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  8933. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  8934. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  8935. @item sigma
  8936. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  8937. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  8938. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  8939. @end table
  8940. @subsection Examples
  8941. @itemize
  8942. @item
  8943. Grey Edge:
  8944. @example
  8945. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  8946. @end example
  8947. @item
  8948. Max Edge:
  8949. @example
  8950. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  8951. @end example
  8952. @end itemize
  8953. @anchor{haldclut}
  8954. @section haldclut
  8955. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  8956. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  8957. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  8958. The filter accepts the following options:
  8959. @table @option
  8960. @item shortest
  8961. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  8962. @item repeatlast
  8963. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  8964. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  8965. Default is @code{1}.
  8966. @end table
  8967. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  8968. filters share the same internals).
  8969. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  8970. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  8971. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  8972. @subsection Workflow examples
  8973. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  8974. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  8975. @example
  8976. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  8977. @end example
  8978. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  8979. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  8980. @example
  8981. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  8982. @end example
  8983. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  8984. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  8985. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  8986. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  8987. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  8988. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  8989. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  8990. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  8991. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  8992. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  8993. @code{haldclut} filter:
  8994. @example
  8995. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  8996. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  8997. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  8998. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  8999. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  9000. @end example
  9001. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  9002. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  9003. the color changes.
  9004. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  9005. @example
  9006. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  9007. @end example
  9008. @section hflip
  9009. Flip the input video horizontally.
  9010. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9011. @example
  9012. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  9013. @end example
  9014. @section histeq
  9015. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  9016. per-frame basis.
  9017. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  9018. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  9019. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  9020. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  9021. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  9022. video.
  9023. The filter accepts the following options:
  9024. @table @option
  9025. @item strength
  9026. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  9027. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  9028. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  9029. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  9030. @item intensity
  9031. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  9032. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  9033. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  9034. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  9035. @item antibanding
  9036. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  9037. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  9038. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  9039. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  9040. @end table
  9041. @anchor{histogram}
  9042. @section histogram
  9043. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  9044. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  9045. distribution in an image.
  9046. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  9047. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  9048. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  9049. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  9050. The filter accepts the following options:
  9051. @table @option
  9052. @item level_height
  9053. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  9054. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  9055. @item scale_height
  9056. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  9057. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  9058. @item display_mode
  9059. Set display mode.
  9060. It accepts the following values:
  9061. @table @samp
  9062. @item stack
  9063. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  9064. @item parade
  9065. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  9066. @item overlay
  9067. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  9068. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  9069. over one another.
  9070. @end table
  9071. Default is @code{stack}.
  9072. @item levels_mode
  9073. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  9074. Default is @code{linear}.
  9075. @item components
  9076. Set what color components to display.
  9077. Default is @code{7}.
  9078. @item fgopacity
  9079. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  9080. @item bgopacity
  9081. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  9082. @end table
  9083. @subsection Examples
  9084. @itemize
  9085. @item
  9086. Calculate and draw histogram:
  9087. @example
  9088. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  9089. @end example
  9090. @end itemize
  9091. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  9092. @section hqdn3d
  9093. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  9094. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  9095. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  9096. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9097. @table @option
  9098. @item luma_spatial
  9099. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  9100. It defaults to 4.0.
  9101. @item chroma_spatial
  9102. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  9103. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9104. @item luma_tmp
  9105. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9106. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9107. @item chroma_tmp
  9108. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9109. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  9110. @end table
  9111. @subsection Commands
  9112. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9113. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9114. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9115. value.
  9116. @anchor{hwdownload}
  9117. @section hwdownload
  9118. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  9119. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  9120. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  9121. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  9122. the output in a supported format.
  9123. @section hwmap
  9124. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  9125. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  9126. on the input and output formats:
  9127. @itemize
  9128. @item
  9129. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  9130. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  9131. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  9132. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  9133. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  9134. @item
  9135. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  9136. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  9137. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  9138. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  9139. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  9140. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  9141. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  9142. the input is already in a compatible format.
  9143. @item
  9144. Hardware frame input and output
  9145. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  9146. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  9147. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9148. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9149. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9150. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  9151. to retrieve the original frames.
  9152. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  9153. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  9154. @end itemize
  9155. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9156. @table @option
  9157. @item mode
  9158. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  9159. @table @var
  9160. @item read
  9161. The mapped frame should be readable.
  9162. @item write
  9163. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  9164. @item overwrite
  9165. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  9166. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  9167. frame need not be loaded.
  9168. @item direct
  9169. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  9170. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  9171. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  9172. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  9173. not possible.
  9174. @end table
  9175. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  9176. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9177. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9178. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9179. @item reverse
  9180. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  9181. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  9182. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  9183. supported by the devices being used.
  9184. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  9185. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  9186. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  9187. @end table
  9188. @anchor{hwupload}
  9189. @section hwupload
  9190. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  9191. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  9192. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  9193. option or with the @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices
  9194. must be of different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9195. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9196. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9197. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9198. @table @option
  9199. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9200. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9201. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9202. @end table
  9203. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  9204. @section hwupload_cuda
  9205. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  9206. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9207. @table @option
  9208. @item device
  9209. The number of the CUDA device to use
  9210. @end table
  9211. @section hqx
  9212. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  9213. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  9214. It accepts the following option:
  9215. @table @option
  9216. @item n
  9217. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  9218. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  9219. Default is @code{3}.
  9220. @end table
  9221. @section hstack
  9222. Stack input videos horizontally.
  9223. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  9224. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9225. to create same output.
  9226. The filter accepts the following option:
  9227. @table @option
  9228. @item inputs
  9229. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9230. @item shortest
  9231. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9232. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9233. @end table
  9234. @section hue
  9235. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  9236. It accepts the following parameters:
  9237. @table @option
  9238. @item h
  9239. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  9240. and defaults to "0".
  9241. @item s
  9242. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9243. defaults to "1".
  9244. @item H
  9245. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  9246. expression, and defaults to "0".
  9247. @item b
  9248. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9249. defaults to "0".
  9250. @end table
  9251. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  9252. specified at the same time.
  9253. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  9254. expressions containing the following constants:
  9255. @table @option
  9256. @item n
  9257. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  9258. @item pts
  9259. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  9260. @item r
  9261. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9262. @item t
  9263. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  9264. @item tb
  9265. time base of the input video
  9266. @end table
  9267. @subsection Examples
  9268. @itemize
  9269. @item
  9270. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  9271. @example
  9272. hue=h=90:s=1
  9273. @end example
  9274. @item
  9275. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  9276. @example
  9277. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  9278. @end example
  9279. @item
  9280. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  9281. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  9282. @example
  9283. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  9284. @end example
  9285. @item
  9286. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  9287. @example
  9288. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  9289. @end example
  9290. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  9291. @example
  9292. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  9293. @end example
  9294. @item
  9295. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  9296. @example
  9297. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  9298. @end example
  9299. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  9300. @example
  9301. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  9302. @end example
  9303. @end itemize
  9304. @subsection Commands
  9305. This filter supports the following commands:
  9306. @table @option
  9307. @item b
  9308. @item s
  9309. @item h
  9310. @item H
  9311. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  9312. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9313. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9314. value.
  9315. @end table
  9316. @section hysteresis
  9317. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  9318. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  9319. This filter accepts the following options:
  9320. @table @option
  9321. @item planes
  9322. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9323. copied from first stream.
  9324. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9325. @item threshold
  9326. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  9327. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  9328. By default value is 0.
  9329. @end table
  9330. @section idet
  9331. Detect video interlacing type.
  9332. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  9333. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  9334. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  9335. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  9336. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  9337. The filter will log these metadata values:
  9338. @table @option
  9339. @item single.current_frame
  9340. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  9341. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9342. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9343. @item single.tff
  9344. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9345. @item multiple.tff
  9346. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9347. @item single.bff
  9348. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9349. @item multiple.current_frame
  9350. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9351. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9352. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9353. @item multiple.bff
  9354. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9355. @item single.progressive
  9356. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9357. @item multiple.progressive
  9358. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9359. @item single.undetermined
  9360. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9361. @item multiple.undetermined
  9362. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9363. @item repeated.current_frame
  9364. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9365. @item repeated.neither
  9366. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9367. @item repeated.top
  9368. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9369. @item repeated.bottom
  9370. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9371. @end table
  9372. The filter accepts the following options:
  9373. @table @option
  9374. @item intl_thres
  9375. Set interlacing threshold.
  9376. @item prog_thres
  9377. Set progressive threshold.
  9378. @item rep_thres
  9379. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9380. @item half_life
  9381. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9382. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9383. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9384. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9385. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9386. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9387. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9388. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9389. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9390. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9391. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9392. @end table
  9393. @section il
  9394. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9395. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9396. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9397. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9398. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9399. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9400. The filter accepts the following options:
  9401. @table @option
  9402. @item luma_mode, l
  9403. @item chroma_mode, c
  9404. @item alpha_mode, a
  9405. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9406. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9407. @table @samp
  9408. @item none
  9409. Do nothing.
  9410. @item deinterleave, d
  9411. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9412. @item interleave, i
  9413. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9414. @end table
  9415. Default value is @code{none}.
  9416. @item luma_swap, ls
  9417. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9418. @item alpha_swap, as
  9419. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9420. @end table
  9421. @subsection Commands
  9422. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9423. @section inflate
  9424. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9425. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9426. only values higher than the pixel.
  9427. It accepts the following options:
  9428. @table @option
  9429. @item threshold0
  9430. @item threshold1
  9431. @item threshold2
  9432. @item threshold3
  9433. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9434. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9435. @end table
  9436. @subsection Commands
  9437. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9438. @section interlace
  9439. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9440. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9441. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9442. @example
  9443. Original Original New Frame
  9444. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9445. ========== =========== ==================
  9446. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9447. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9448. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9449. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9450. ... ... ...
  9451. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9452. @end example
  9453. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9454. @table @option
  9455. @item scan
  9456. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9457. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9458. @item lowpass
  9459. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9460. reduce moire patterns.
  9461. @table @samp
  9462. @item 0, off
  9463. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9464. @item 1, linear
  9465. Enable linear filter (default)
  9466. @item 2, complex
  9467. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9468. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9469. @end table
  9470. @end table
  9471. @section kerndeint
  9472. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9473. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9474. progressive frames.
  9475. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9476. @table @option
  9477. @item thresh
  9478. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9479. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9480. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9481. applying the process on every pixels.
  9482. @item map
  9483. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9484. Default is 0.
  9485. @item order
  9486. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9487. 0. Default is 0.
  9488. @item sharp
  9489. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9490. @item twoway
  9491. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9492. @end table
  9493. @subsection Examples
  9494. @itemize
  9495. @item
  9496. Apply default values:
  9497. @example
  9498. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9499. @end example
  9500. @item
  9501. Enable additional sharpening:
  9502. @example
  9503. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9504. @end example
  9505. @item
  9506. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9507. @example
  9508. kerndeint=map=1
  9509. @end example
  9510. @end itemize
  9511. @section lagfun
  9512. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9513. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9514. This filter accepts the following options:
  9515. @table @option
  9516. @item decay
  9517. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9518. @item planes
  9519. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9520. @end table
  9521. @section lenscorrection
  9522. Correct radial lens distortion
  9523. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9524. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9525. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9526. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9527. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9528. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9529. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9530. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9531. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9532. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9533. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9534. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9535. @subsection Options
  9536. The filter accepts the following options:
  9537. @table @option
  9538. @item cx
  9539. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9540. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9541. width. Default is 0.5.
  9542. @item cy
  9543. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9544. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9545. height. Default is 0.5.
  9546. @item k1
  9547. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9548. no correction. Default is 0.
  9549. @item k2
  9550. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9551. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9552. @end table
  9553. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9554. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9555. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9556. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9557. @section lensfun
  9558. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9559. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9560. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9561. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9562. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9563. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9564. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9565. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9566. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9567. The filter accepts the following options:
  9568. @table @option
  9569. @item make
  9570. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9571. @item model
  9572. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9573. required.
  9574. @item lens_model
  9575. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9576. option is required.
  9577. @item mode
  9578. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9579. @table @samp
  9580. @item vignetting
  9581. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9582. @item geometry
  9583. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9584. @item subpixel
  9585. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9586. @item vig_geo
  9587. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9588. @item vig_subpixel
  9589. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9590. @item distortion
  9591. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9592. @item all
  9593. Enables all possible corrections.
  9594. @end table
  9595. @item focal_length
  9596. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9597. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9598. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9599. @item aperture
  9600. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9601. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9602. @item focus_distance
  9603. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9604. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9605. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9606. is 1000).
  9607. @item scale
  9608. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9609. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9610. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9611. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9612. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9613. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9614. unmapped areas in the output.
  9615. @item target_geometry
  9616. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9617. options:
  9618. @table @samp
  9619. @item rectilinear (default)
  9620. @item fisheye
  9621. @item panoramic
  9622. @item equirectangular
  9623. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9624. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9625. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9626. @item fisheye_thoby
  9627. @end table
  9628. @item reverse
  9629. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9630. it).
  9631. @item interpolation
  9632. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9633. are valid options:
  9634. @table @samp
  9635. @item nearest
  9636. @item linear (default)
  9637. @item lanczos
  9638. @end table
  9639. @end table
  9640. @subsection Examples
  9641. @itemize
  9642. @item
  9643. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9644. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9645. aperture of "8.0".
  9646. @example
  9647. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9648. @end example
  9649. @item
  9650. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9651. @example
  9652. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9653. @end example
  9654. @end itemize
  9655. @section libvmaf
  9656. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9657. score between two input videos.
  9658. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9659. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9660. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9661. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9662. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9663. The filter has following options:
  9664. @table @option
  9665. @item model_path
  9666. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9667. Default value: @code{"/usr/local/share/model/vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9668. @item log_path
  9669. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9670. @item log_fmt
  9671. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9672. @item enable_transform
  9673. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9674. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9675. Default value: @code{false}
  9676. @item phone_model
  9677. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9678. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9679. Default value: @code{false}
  9680. @item psnr
  9681. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9682. Default value: @code{false}
  9683. @item ssim
  9684. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9685. Default value: @code{false}
  9686. @item ms_ssim
  9687. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9688. Default value: @code{false}
  9689. @item pool
  9690. Set the pool method to be used for computing vmaf.
  9691. Options are @code{min}, @code{harmonic_mean} or @code{mean} (default).
  9692. @item n_threads
  9693. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9694. Default value: @code{0}, which makes use of all available logical processors.
  9695. @item n_subsample
  9696. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9697. Default value: @code{1}
  9698. @item enable_conf_interval
  9699. Enables confidence interval.
  9700. Default value: @code{false}
  9701. @end table
  9702. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9703. @subsection Examples
  9704. @itemize
  9705. @item
  9706. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9707. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9708. @example
  9709. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9710. @end example
  9711. @item
  9712. Example with options:
  9713. @example
  9714. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9715. @end example
  9716. @item
  9717. Example with options and different containers:
  9718. @example
  9719. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9720. @end example
  9721. @end itemize
  9722. @section limiter
  9723. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9724. The filter accepts the following options:
  9725. @table @option
  9726. @item min
  9727. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9728. @item max
  9729. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9730. @item planes
  9731. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9732. @end table
  9733. @section loop
  9734. Loop video frames.
  9735. The filter accepts the following options:
  9736. @table @option
  9737. @item loop
  9738. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9739. Default is 0.
  9740. @item size
  9741. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9742. @item start
  9743. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9744. @end table
  9745. @subsection Examples
  9746. @itemize
  9747. @item
  9748. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9749. @example
  9750. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9751. @end example
  9752. @item
  9753. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9754. @example
  9755. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9756. @end example
  9757. @item
  9758. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9759. @example
  9760. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9761. @end example
  9762. @end itemize
  9763. @section lut1d
  9764. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9765. The filter accepts the following options:
  9766. @table @option
  9767. @item file
  9768. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9769. Currently supported formats:
  9770. @table @samp
  9771. @item cube
  9772. Iridas
  9773. @item csp
  9774. cineSpace
  9775. @end table
  9776. @item interp
  9777. Select interpolation mode.
  9778. Available values are:
  9779. @table @samp
  9780. @item nearest
  9781. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9782. @item linear
  9783. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9784. @item cosine
  9785. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9786. @item cubic
  9787. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9788. @item spline
  9789. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9790. @end table
  9791. @end table
  9792. @anchor{lut3d}
  9793. @section lut3d
  9794. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9795. The filter accepts the following options:
  9796. @table @option
  9797. @item file
  9798. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9799. Currently supported formats:
  9800. @table @samp
  9801. @item 3dl
  9802. AfterEffects
  9803. @item cube
  9804. Iridas
  9805. @item dat
  9806. DaVinci
  9807. @item m3d
  9808. Pandora
  9809. @item csp
  9810. cineSpace
  9811. @end table
  9812. @item interp
  9813. Select interpolation mode.
  9814. Available values are:
  9815. @table @samp
  9816. @item nearest
  9817. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9818. @item trilinear
  9819. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9820. @item tetrahedral
  9821. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9822. @end table
  9823. @end table
  9824. @section lumakey
  9825. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9826. The filter accepts the following options:
  9827. @table @option
  9828. @item threshold
  9829. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9830. Default value is @code{0}.
  9831. @item tolerance
  9832. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9833. Default value is @code{0.01}.
  9834. @item softness
  9835. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9836. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9837. @end table
  9838. @subsection Commands
  9839. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9840. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9841. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9842. value.
  9843. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9844. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9845. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9846. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9847. to an RGB input video.
  9848. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9849. @table @option
  9850. @item c0
  9851. set first pixel component expression
  9852. @item c1
  9853. set second pixel component expression
  9854. @item c2
  9855. set third pixel component expression
  9856. @item c3
  9857. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9858. @item r
  9859. set red component expression
  9860. @item g
  9861. set green component expression
  9862. @item b
  9863. set blue component expression
  9864. @item a
  9865. alpha component expression
  9866. @item y
  9867. set Y/luminance component expression
  9868. @item u
  9869. set U/Cb component expression
  9870. @item v
  9871. set V/Cr component expression
  9872. @end table
  9873. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9874. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9875. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9876. format in input.
  9877. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9878. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9879. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9880. @table @option
  9881. @item w
  9882. @item h
  9883. The input width and height.
  9884. @item val
  9885. The input value for the pixel component.
  9886. @item clipval
  9887. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9888. @item maxval
  9889. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9890. @item minval
  9891. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  9892. @item negval
  9893. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  9894. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  9895. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  9896. @item clip(val)
  9897. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  9898. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9899. @item gammaval(gamma)
  9900. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  9901. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  9902. expression
  9903. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  9904. @end table
  9905. All expressions default to "val".
  9906. @subsection Examples
  9907. @itemize
  9908. @item
  9909. Negate input video:
  9910. @example
  9911. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  9912. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  9913. @end example
  9914. The above is the same as:
  9915. @example
  9916. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  9917. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  9918. @end example
  9919. @item
  9920. Negate luminance:
  9921. @example
  9922. lutyuv=y=negval
  9923. @end example
  9924. @item
  9925. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  9926. @example
  9927. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  9928. @end example
  9929. @item
  9930. Apply a luma burning effect:
  9931. @example
  9932. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  9933. @end example
  9934. @item
  9935. Remove green and blue components:
  9936. @example
  9937. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  9938. @end example
  9939. @item
  9940. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  9941. @example
  9942. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  9943. @end example
  9944. @item
  9945. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  9946. @example
  9947. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  9948. @end example
  9949. @item
  9950. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  9951. @example
  9952. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  9953. @end example
  9954. @item
  9955. Technicolor like effect:
  9956. @example
  9957. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  9958. @end example
  9959. @end itemize
  9960. @section lut2, tlut2
  9961. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  9962. stream.
  9963. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  9964. from one single stream.
  9965. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  9966. @table @option
  9967. @item c0
  9968. set first pixel component expression
  9969. @item c1
  9970. set second pixel component expression
  9971. @item c2
  9972. set third pixel component expression
  9973. @item c3
  9974. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9975. @item d
  9976. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  9977. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  9978. @end table
  9979. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9980. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9981. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9982. format in inputs.
  9983. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  9984. @table @option
  9985. @item w
  9986. @item h
  9987. The input width and height.
  9988. @item x
  9989. The first input value for the pixel component.
  9990. @item y
  9991. The second input value for the pixel component.
  9992. @item bdx
  9993. The first input video bit depth.
  9994. @item bdy
  9995. The second input video bit depth.
  9996. @end table
  9997. All expressions default to "x".
  9998. @subsection Examples
  9999. @itemize
  10000. @item
  10001. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  10002. @example
  10003. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10004. @end example
  10005. @item
  10006. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  10007. @example
  10008. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10009. @end example
  10010. @item
  10011. Show max difference between two video streams:
  10012. @example
  10013. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  10014. @end example
  10015. @end itemize
  10016. @section maskedclamp
  10017. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  10018. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  10019. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  10020. This filter accepts the following options:
  10021. @table @option
  10022. @item undershoot
  10023. Default value is @code{0}.
  10024. @item overshoot
  10025. Default value is @code{0}.
  10026. @item planes
  10027. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10028. copied from first stream.
  10029. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10030. @end table
  10031. @section maskedmax
  10032. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10033. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10034. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10035. stream if second absolute difference is greater than first one or from third input stream
  10036. otherwise.
  10037. This filter accepts the following options:
  10038. @table @option
  10039. @item planes
  10040. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10041. copied from first stream.
  10042. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10043. @end table
  10044. @section maskedmerge
  10045. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  10046. weights in the third input stream.
  10047. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  10048. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  10049. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  10050. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  10051. input stream's pixel components.
  10052. This filter accepts the following options:
  10053. @table @option
  10054. @item planes
  10055. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10056. copied from first stream.
  10057. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10058. @end table
  10059. @section maskedmin
  10060. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10061. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10062. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10063. stream if second absolute difference is less than first one or from third input stream
  10064. otherwise.
  10065. This filter accepts the following options:
  10066. @table @option
  10067. @item planes
  10068. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10069. copied from first stream.
  10070. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10071. @end table
  10072. @section maskfun
  10073. Create mask from input video.
  10074. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  10075. This filter accepts the following options:
  10076. @table @option
  10077. @item low
  10078. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  10079. @item high
  10080. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  10081. allowed for current pixel format.
  10082. @item planes
  10083. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  10084. @item fill
  10085. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  10086. @item sum
  10087. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  10088. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  10089. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  10090. @end table
  10091. @section mcdeint
  10092. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  10093. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  10094. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  10095. This filter accepts the following options:
  10096. @table @option
  10097. @item mode
  10098. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  10099. It accepts one of the following values:
  10100. @table @samp
  10101. @item fast
  10102. @item medium
  10103. @item slow
  10104. use iterative motion estimation
  10105. @item extra_slow
  10106. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  10107. @end table
  10108. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  10109. @item parity
  10110. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  10111. one of the following values:
  10112. @table @samp
  10113. @item 0, tff
  10114. assume top field first
  10115. @item 1, bff
  10116. assume bottom field first
  10117. @end table
  10118. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  10119. @item qp
  10120. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  10121. encoder.
  10122. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  10123. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  10124. @end table
  10125. @section median
  10126. Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.
  10127. This filter accepts the following options:
  10128. @table @option
  10129. @item radius
  10130. Set horizontal radius size. Default value is @code{1}.
  10131. Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.
  10132. @item planes
  10133. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10134. @item radiusV
  10135. Set vertical radius size. Default value is @code{0}.
  10136. Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.
  10137. If it is 0, value will be picked from horizontal @code{radius} option.
  10138. @item percentile
  10139. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  10140. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  10141. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  10142. @end table
  10143. @subsection Commands
  10144. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10145. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10146. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10147. value.
  10148. @section mergeplanes
  10149. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  10150. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  10151. planes to the output video.
  10152. This filter accepts the following options:
  10153. @table @option
  10154. @item mapping
  10155. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  10156. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  10157. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  10158. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  10159. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  10160. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  10161. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  10162. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  10163. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  10164. @item format
  10165. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  10166. @end table
  10167. @subsection Examples
  10168. @itemize
  10169. @item
  10170. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  10171. @example
  10172. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  10173. @end example
  10174. @item
  10175. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  10176. @example
  10177. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  10178. @end example
  10179. @item
  10180. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  10181. @example
  10182. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  10183. @end example
  10184. @item
  10185. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  10186. @example
  10187. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  10188. @end example
  10189. @item
  10190. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  10191. @example
  10192. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  10193. @end example
  10194. @end itemize
  10195. @section mestimate
  10196. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  10197. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  10198. This filter accepts the following options:
  10199. @table @option
  10200. @item method
  10201. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  10202. @table @samp
  10203. @item esa
  10204. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10205. @item tss
  10206. Three step search algorithm.
  10207. @item tdls
  10208. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10209. @item ntss
  10210. New three step search algorithm.
  10211. @item fss
  10212. Four step search algorithm.
  10213. @item ds
  10214. Diamond search algorithm.
  10215. @item hexbs
  10216. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10217. @item epzs
  10218. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10219. @item umh
  10220. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10221. @end table
  10222. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  10223. @item mb_size
  10224. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10225. @item search_param
  10226. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  10227. @end table
  10228. @section midequalizer
  10229. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  10230. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  10231. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  10232. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  10233. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  10234. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  10235. midway histogram of both inputs.
  10236. This filter accepts the following option:
  10237. @table @option
  10238. @item planes
  10239. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10240. @end table
  10241. @section minterpolate
  10242. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  10243. This filter accepts the following options:
  10244. @table @option
  10245. @item fps
  10246. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  10247. @item mi_mode
  10248. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10249. @table @samp
  10250. @item dup
  10251. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  10252. @item blend
  10253. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  10254. @item mci
  10255. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  10256. @table @samp
  10257. @item mc_mode
  10258. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10259. @table @samp
  10260. @item obmc
  10261. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  10262. @item aobmc
  10263. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  10264. @end table
  10265. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  10266. @item me_mode
  10267. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10268. @table @samp
  10269. @item bidir
  10270. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  10271. @item bilat
  10272. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  10273. @end table
  10274. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  10275. @item me
  10276. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  10277. @table @samp
  10278. @item esa
  10279. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10280. @item tss
  10281. Three step search algorithm.
  10282. @item tdls
  10283. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10284. @item ntss
  10285. New three step search algorithm.
  10286. @item fss
  10287. Four step search algorithm.
  10288. @item ds
  10289. Diamond search algorithm.
  10290. @item hexbs
  10291. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10292. @item epzs
  10293. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10294. @item umh
  10295. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10296. @end table
  10297. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  10298. @item mb_size
  10299. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10300. @item search_param
  10301. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  10302. @item vsbmc
  10303. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  10304. @end table
  10305. @end table
  10306. @item scd
  10307. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  10308. @table @samp
  10309. @item none
  10310. Disable scene change detection.
  10311. @item fdiff
  10312. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  10313. @end table
  10314. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  10315. @item scd_threshold
  10316. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  10317. @end table
  10318. @section mix
  10319. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  10320. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10321. @table @option
  10322. @item nb_inputs
  10323. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  10324. @item weights
  10325. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  10326. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  10327. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  10328. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  10329. @item scale
  10330. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  10331. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  10332. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  10333. @item duration
  10334. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  10335. @table @samp
  10336. @item longest
  10337. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  10338. @item shortest
  10339. The duration of the shortest input.
  10340. @item first
  10341. The duration of the first input.
  10342. @end table
  10343. @end table
  10344. @section mpdecimate
  10345. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  10346. order to reduce frame rate.
  10347. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  10348. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  10349. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  10350. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10351. @table @option
  10352. @item max
  10353. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  10354. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  10355. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  10356. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  10357. Default value is 0.
  10358. @item hi
  10359. @item lo
  10360. @item frac
  10361. Set the dropping threshold values.
  10362. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  10363. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  10364. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  10365. out differently over the block.
  10366. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  10367. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  10368. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  10369. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  10370. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  10371. @end table
  10372. @section negate
  10373. Negate (invert) the input video.
  10374. It accepts the following option:
  10375. @table @option
  10376. @item negate_alpha
  10377. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  10378. @end table
  10379. @anchor{nlmeans}
  10380. @section nlmeans
  10381. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  10382. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  10383. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  10384. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  10385. around the pixel.
  10386. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  10387. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  10388. The filter accepts the following options.
  10389. @table @option
  10390. @item s
  10391. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  10392. @item p
  10393. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10394. @item pc
  10395. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  10396. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10397. @item r
  10398. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10399. @item rc
  10400. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  10401. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10402. @end table
  10403. @section nnedi
  10404. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  10405. This filter accepts the following options:
  10406. @table @option
  10407. @item weights
  10408. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  10409. Currently file can be found here:
  10410. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  10411. @item deint
  10412. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  10413. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  10414. @item field
  10415. Set mode of operation.
  10416. Can be one of the following:
  10417. @table @samp
  10418. @item af
  10419. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10420. @item a
  10421. Use frame flags, single field.
  10422. @item t
  10423. Use top field only.
  10424. @item b
  10425. Use bottom field only.
  10426. @item tf
  10427. Use both fields, top first.
  10428. @item bf
  10429. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10430. @end table
  10431. @item planes
  10432. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10433. @item nsize
  10434. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10435. network.
  10436. Can be one of the following:
  10437. @table @samp
  10438. @item s8x6
  10439. @item s16x6
  10440. @item s32x6
  10441. @item s48x6
  10442. @item s8x4
  10443. @item s16x4
  10444. @item s32x4
  10445. @end table
  10446. @item nns
  10447. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10448. Can be one of the following:
  10449. @table @samp
  10450. @item n16
  10451. @item n32
  10452. @item n64
  10453. @item n128
  10454. @item n256
  10455. @end table
  10456. @item qual
  10457. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10458. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10459. @code{slow}.
  10460. @item etype
  10461. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10462. Can be one of the following:
  10463. @table @samp
  10464. @item a
  10465. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10466. @item s
  10467. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10468. @end table
  10469. @item pscrn
  10470. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10471. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10472. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10473. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10474. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10475. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10476. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10477. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10478. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10479. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10480. Can be one of the following:
  10481. @table @samp
  10482. @item none
  10483. @item original
  10484. @item new
  10485. @end table
  10486. Default is @code{new}.
  10487. @item fapprox
  10488. Set various debugging flags.
  10489. @end table
  10490. @section noformat
  10491. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10492. input to the next filter.
  10493. It accepts the following parameters:
  10494. @table @option
  10495. @item pix_fmts
  10496. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10497. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10498. @end table
  10499. @subsection Examples
  10500. @itemize
  10501. @item
  10502. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10503. input to the vflip filter:
  10504. @example
  10505. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10506. @end example
  10507. @item
  10508. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10509. @example
  10510. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10511. @end example
  10512. @end itemize
  10513. @section noise
  10514. Add noise on video input frame.
  10515. The filter accepts the following options:
  10516. @table @option
  10517. @item all_seed
  10518. @item c0_seed
  10519. @item c1_seed
  10520. @item c2_seed
  10521. @item c3_seed
  10522. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10523. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10524. @item all_strength, alls
  10525. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10526. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10527. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10528. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10529. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10530. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10531. @item all_flags, allf
  10532. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10533. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10534. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10535. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10536. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10537. Available values for component flags are:
  10538. @table @samp
  10539. @item a
  10540. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10541. @item p
  10542. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10543. @item t
  10544. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10545. @item u
  10546. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10547. @end table
  10548. @end table
  10549. @subsection Examples
  10550. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10551. @example
  10552. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10553. @end example
  10554. @section normalize
  10555. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10556. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10557. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10558. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10559. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10560. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10561. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10562. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10563. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10564. under-exposure of the video.
  10565. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10566. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10567. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10568. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10569. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10570. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10571. @table @option
  10572. @item blackpt
  10573. @item whitept
  10574. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10575. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10576. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10577. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10578. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10579. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10580. effects.
  10581. @item smoothing
  10582. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10583. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10584. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10585. smoothing).
  10586. @item independence
  10587. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10588. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10589. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10590. @item strength
  10591. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10592. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10593. @end table
  10594. @subsection Commands
  10595. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options, excluding @var{smoothing} option.
  10596. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10597. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10598. value.
  10599. @subsection Examples
  10600. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10601. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10602. @example
  10603. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10604. @end example
  10605. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10606. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10607. @example
  10608. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10609. @end example
  10610. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10611. @example
  10612. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10613. @end example
  10614. As above, but with half strength:
  10615. @example
  10616. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10617. @end example
  10618. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10619. @example
  10620. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10621. @end example
  10622. @section null
  10623. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10624. @section ocr
  10625. Optical Character Recognition
  10626. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10627. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10628. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10629. It accepts the following options:
  10630. @table @option
  10631. @item datapath
  10632. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10633. set at installation.
  10634. @item language
  10635. Set language, default is "eng".
  10636. @item whitelist
  10637. Set character whitelist.
  10638. @item blacklist
  10639. Set character blacklist.
  10640. @end table
  10641. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10642. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10643. @section ocv
  10644. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10645. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10646. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10647. It accepts the following parameters:
  10648. @table @option
  10649. @item filter_name
  10650. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10651. @item filter_params
  10652. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10653. values are assumed.
  10654. @end table
  10655. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10656. information:
  10657. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10658. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10659. @anchor{dilate}
  10660. @subsection dilate
  10661. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10662. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10663. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10664. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10665. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10666. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10667. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10668. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10669. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10670. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10671. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10672. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10673. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10674. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10675. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10676. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10677. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10678. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10679. Some examples:
  10680. @example
  10681. # Use the default values
  10682. ocv=dilate
  10683. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10684. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10685. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10686. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10687. # *
  10688. # ***
  10689. # *****
  10690. # ***
  10691. # *
  10692. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10693. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10694. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10695. @end example
  10696. @subsection erode
  10697. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10698. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10699. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10700. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10701. @subsection smooth
  10702. Smooth the input video.
  10703. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10704. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10705. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10706. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10707. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10708. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10709. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10710. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10711. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10712. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10713. other parameters is 0.
  10714. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10715. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10716. @section oscilloscope
  10717. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10718. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10719. It accepts the following parameters:
  10720. @table @option
  10721. @item x
  10722. Set scope center x position.
  10723. @item y
  10724. Set scope center y position.
  10725. @item s
  10726. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10727. @item t
  10728. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10729. @item o
  10730. Set trace opacity.
  10731. @item tx
  10732. Set trace center x position.
  10733. @item ty
  10734. Set trace center y position.
  10735. @item tw
  10736. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10737. @item th
  10738. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10739. @item c
  10740. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10741. @item g
  10742. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10743. @item st
  10744. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10745. @item sc
  10746. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10747. @end table
  10748. @subsection Commands
  10749. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10750. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10751. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10752. value.
  10753. @subsection Examples
  10754. @itemize
  10755. @item
  10756. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10757. @example
  10758. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10759. @end example
  10760. @item
  10761. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10762. @example
  10763. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10764. @end example
  10765. @item
  10766. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10767. @example
  10768. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10769. @end example
  10770. @item
  10771. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10772. @example
  10773. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10774. @end example
  10775. @end itemize
  10776. @anchor{overlay}
  10777. @section overlay
  10778. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10779. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10780. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10781. It accepts the following parameters:
  10782. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10783. @table @option
  10784. @item x
  10785. @item y
  10786. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10787. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10788. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10789. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10790. @item eof_action
  10791. See @ref{framesync}.
  10792. @item eval
  10793. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10794. It accepts the following values:
  10795. @table @samp
  10796. @item init
  10797. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10798. when a command is processed
  10799. @item frame
  10800. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10801. @end table
  10802. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10803. @item shortest
  10804. See @ref{framesync}.
  10805. @item format
  10806. Set the format for the output video.
  10807. It accepts the following values:
  10808. @table @samp
  10809. @item yuv420
  10810. force YUV420 output
  10811. @item yuv422
  10812. force YUV422 output
  10813. @item yuv444
  10814. force YUV444 output
  10815. @item rgb
  10816. force packed RGB output
  10817. @item gbrp
  10818. force planar RGB output
  10819. @item auto
  10820. automatically pick format
  10821. @end table
  10822. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10823. @item repeatlast
  10824. See @ref{framesync}.
  10825. @item alpha
  10826. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10827. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10828. @end table
  10829. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10830. parameters.
  10831. @table @option
  10832. @item main_w, W
  10833. @item main_h, H
  10834. The main input width and height.
  10835. @item overlay_w, w
  10836. @item overlay_h, h
  10837. The overlay input width and height.
  10838. @item x
  10839. @item y
  10840. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10841. each new frame.
  10842. @item hsub
  10843. @item vsub
  10844. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10845. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10846. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10847. @item n
  10848. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10849. @item pos
  10850. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10851. @item t
  10852. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10853. @end table
  10854. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10855. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10856. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10857. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10858. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10859. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10860. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10861. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10862. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10863. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10864. efficiency of such approach.
  10865. @subsection Commands
  10866. This filter supports the following commands:
  10867. @table @option
  10868. @item x
  10869. @item y
  10870. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  10871. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10872. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10873. value.
  10874. @end table
  10875. @subsection Examples
  10876. @itemize
  10877. @item
  10878. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  10879. video:
  10880. @example
  10881. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  10882. @end example
  10883. Using named options the example above becomes:
  10884. @example
  10885. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  10886. @end example
  10887. @item
  10888. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  10889. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  10890. @example
  10891. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  10892. @end example
  10893. @item
  10894. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  10895. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  10896. @example
  10897. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  10898. @end example
  10899. @item
  10900. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  10901. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  10902. @example
  10903. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  10904. @end example
  10905. @item
  10906. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  10907. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  10908. @example
  10909. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  10910. @end example
  10911. The above command is the same as:
  10912. @example
  10913. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  10914. @end example
  10915. @item
  10916. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  10917. screen starting since time 2:
  10918. @example
  10919. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  10920. @end example
  10921. @item
  10922. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  10923. @example
  10924. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  10925. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  10926. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  10927. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  10928. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  10929. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  10930. "
  10931. @end example
  10932. @item
  10933. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  10934. @example
  10935. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  10936. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  10937. masked.avi
  10938. @end example
  10939. @item
  10940. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  10941. @example
  10942. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  10943. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  10944. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  10945. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  10946. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  10947. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  10948. @end example
  10949. @end itemize
  10950. @section owdenoise
  10951. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  10952. The filter accepts the following options:
  10953. @table @option
  10954. @item depth
  10955. Set depth.
  10956. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  10957. slow down filtering.
  10958. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  10959. @item luma_strength, ls
  10960. Set luma strength.
  10961. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10962. @item chroma_strength, cs
  10963. Set chroma strength.
  10964. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10965. @end table
  10966. @anchor{pad}
  10967. @section pad
  10968. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  10969. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  10970. It accepts the following parameters:
  10971. @table @option
  10972. @item width, w
  10973. @item height, h
  10974. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  10975. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  10976. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  10977. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  10978. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  10979. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  10980. @item x
  10981. @item y
  10982. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  10983. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  10984. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  10985. expression, and vice versa.
  10986. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  10987. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  10988. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  10989. @item color
  10990. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  10991. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  10992. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10993. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  10994. @item eval
  10995. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  10996. It accepts the following values:
  10997. @table @samp
  10998. @item init
  10999. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  11000. a command is processed.
  11001. @item frame
  11002. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  11003. @end table
  11004. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11005. @item aspect
  11006. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  11007. @end table
  11008. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  11009. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  11010. @table @option
  11011. @item in_w
  11012. @item in_h
  11013. The input video width and height.
  11014. @item iw
  11015. @item ih
  11016. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11017. @item out_w
  11018. @item out_h
  11019. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  11020. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  11021. @item ow
  11022. @item oh
  11023. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  11024. @item x
  11025. @item y
  11026. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  11027. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  11028. @item a
  11029. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11030. @item sar
  11031. input sample aspect ratio
  11032. @item dar
  11033. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  11034. @item hsub
  11035. @item vsub
  11036. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11037. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11038. @end table
  11039. @subsection Examples
  11040. @itemize
  11041. @item
  11042. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  11043. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  11044. column 0, row 40
  11045. @example
  11046. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  11047. @end example
  11048. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  11049. @example
  11050. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  11051. @end example
  11052. @item
  11053. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  11054. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  11055. @example
  11056. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11057. @end example
  11058. @item
  11059. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  11060. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  11061. the center of the padded area:
  11062. @example
  11063. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11064. @end example
  11065. @item
  11066. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  11067. @example
  11068. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11069. @end example
  11070. @item
  11071. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  11072. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  11073. according to the relation:
  11074. @example
  11075. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  11076. X = output_dar / sar
  11077. @end example
  11078. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  11079. @example
  11080. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11081. @end example
  11082. @item
  11083. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  11084. corner of the output padded area:
  11085. @example
  11086. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  11087. @end example
  11088. @end itemize
  11089. @anchor{palettegen}
  11090. @section palettegen
  11091. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  11092. It accepts the following options:
  11093. @table @option
  11094. @item max_colors
  11095. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  11096. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  11097. will be black.
  11098. @item reserve_transparent
  11099. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  11100. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  11101. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  11102. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  11103. Set by default.
  11104. @item transparency_color
  11105. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  11106. @item stats_mode
  11107. Set statistics mode.
  11108. It accepts the following values:
  11109. @table @samp
  11110. @item full
  11111. Compute full frame histograms.
  11112. @item diff
  11113. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  11114. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  11115. the background is static.
  11116. @item single
  11117. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  11118. @end table
  11119. Default value is @var{full}.
  11120. @end table
  11121. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  11122. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  11123. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  11124. @var{info} logging level.
  11125. @subsection Examples
  11126. @itemize
  11127. @item
  11128. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11129. @example
  11130. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  11131. @end example
  11132. @end itemize
  11133. @section paletteuse
  11134. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  11135. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  11136. be a 256 pixels image.
  11137. It accepts the following options:
  11138. @table @option
  11139. @item dither
  11140. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  11141. @table @samp
  11142. @item bayer
  11143. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  11144. @item heckbert
  11145. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  11146. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  11147. reference.
  11148. @item floyd_steinberg
  11149. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  11150. @item sierra2
  11151. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  11152. @item sierra2_4a
  11153. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  11154. @end table
  11155. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  11156. @item bayer_scale
  11157. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  11158. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  11159. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  11160. at the cost of more banding.
  11161. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  11162. @item diff_mode
  11163. If set, define the zone to process
  11164. @table @samp
  11165. @item rectangle
  11166. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  11167. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  11168. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  11169. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  11170. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  11171. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  11172. @end table
  11173. Default is @var{none}.
  11174. @item new
  11175. Take new palette for each output frame.
  11176. @item alpha_threshold
  11177. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  11178. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  11179. treated as completely transparent.
  11180. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  11181. @end table
  11182. @subsection Examples
  11183. @itemize
  11184. @item
  11185. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  11186. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11187. @example
  11188. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  11189. @end example
  11190. @end itemize
  11191. @section perspective
  11192. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  11193. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11194. @table @option
  11195. @item x0
  11196. @item y0
  11197. @item x1
  11198. @item y1
  11199. @item x2
  11200. @item y2
  11201. @item x3
  11202. @item y3
  11203. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  11204. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  11205. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  11206. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  11207. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  11208. The expressions can use the following variables:
  11209. @table @option
  11210. @item W
  11211. @item H
  11212. the width and height of video frame.
  11213. @item in
  11214. Input frame count.
  11215. @item on
  11216. Output frame count.
  11217. @end table
  11218. @item interpolation
  11219. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  11220. It accepts the following values:
  11221. @table @samp
  11222. @item linear
  11223. @item cubic
  11224. @end table
  11225. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  11226. @item sense
  11227. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  11228. It accepts the following values:
  11229. @table @samp
  11230. @item 0, source
  11231. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  11232. the corners of the destination.
  11233. @item 1, destination
  11234. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  11235. by the given coordinates.
  11236. Default value is @samp{source}.
  11237. @end table
  11238. @item eval
  11239. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  11240. It accepts the following values:
  11241. @table @samp
  11242. @item init
  11243. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  11244. when a command is processed
  11245. @item frame
  11246. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  11247. @end table
  11248. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11249. @end table
  11250. @section phase
  11251. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  11252. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  11253. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  11254. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11255. @table @option
  11256. @item mode
  11257. Set phase mode.
  11258. It accepts the following values:
  11259. @table @samp
  11260. @item t
  11261. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  11262. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  11263. @item b
  11264. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  11265. Filter will delay the top field.
  11266. @item p
  11267. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  11268. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  11269. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  11270. @item a
  11271. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  11272. opposite.
  11273. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  11274. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  11275. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  11276. @item u
  11277. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  11278. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  11279. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  11280. match between the fields.
  11281. @item T
  11282. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11283. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11284. @item B
  11285. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11286. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11287. @item A
  11288. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  11289. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  11290. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  11291. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  11292. @item U
  11293. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  11294. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  11295. @end table
  11296. @end table
  11297. @section photosensitivity
  11298. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  11299. It accepts the following options:
  11300. @table @option
  11301. @item frames, f
  11302. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  11303. @item threshold, t
  11304. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  11305. Lower is stricter.
  11306. @item skip
  11307. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.
  11308. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  11309. @item bypass
  11310. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  11311. @end table
  11312. @section pixdesctest
  11313. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  11314. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  11315. For example:
  11316. @example
  11317. format=monow, pixdesctest
  11318. @end example
  11319. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  11320. @section pixscope
  11321. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  11322. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  11323. The filters accept the following options:
  11324. @table @option
  11325. @item x
  11326. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11327. @item y
  11328. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11329. @item w
  11330. Set scope width.
  11331. @item h
  11332. Set scope height.
  11333. @item o
  11334. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  11335. @item wx
  11336. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11337. @item wy
  11338. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11339. @end table
  11340. @section pp
  11341. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  11342. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  11343. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  11344. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  11345. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  11346. The filters accept the following options:
  11347. @table @option
  11348. @item subfilters
  11349. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  11350. @end table
  11351. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  11352. @table @option
  11353. @item a/autoq
  11354. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  11355. @item c/chrom
  11356. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  11357. @item y/nochrom
  11358. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  11359. @item n/noluma
  11360. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  11361. @end table
  11362. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  11363. Available subfilters are:
  11364. @table @option
  11365. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11366. Horizontal deblocking filter
  11367. @table @option
  11368. @item difference
  11369. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11370. @item flatness
  11371. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11372. @end table
  11373. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11374. Vertical deblocking filter
  11375. @table @option
  11376. @item difference
  11377. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11378. @item flatness
  11379. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11380. @end table
  11381. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11382. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  11383. @table @option
  11384. @item difference
  11385. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11386. @item flatness
  11387. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11388. @end table
  11389. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11390. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  11391. @table @option
  11392. @item difference
  11393. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11394. @item flatness
  11395. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11396. @end table
  11397. @end table
  11398. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  11399. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  11400. thresholds.
  11401. @table @option
  11402. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  11403. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  11404. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  11405. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  11406. @item dr/dering
  11407. Deringing filter
  11408. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  11409. @table @option
  11410. @item threshold1
  11411. larger -> stronger filtering
  11412. @item threshold2
  11413. larger -> stronger filtering
  11414. @item threshold3
  11415. larger -> stronger filtering
  11416. @end table
  11417. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  11418. @table @option
  11419. @item f/fullyrange
  11420. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  11421. @end table
  11422. @item lb/linblenddeint
  11423. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11424. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  11425. @item li/linipoldeint
  11426. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11427. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11428. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11429. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11430. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11431. @item md/mediandeint
  11432. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11433. median filter to every second line.
  11434. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11435. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11436. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11437. @item l5/lowpass5
  11438. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11439. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11440. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11441. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11442. specify.
  11443. @table @option
  11444. @item quantizer
  11445. Quantizer to use
  11446. @end table
  11447. @item de/default
  11448. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11449. @item fa/fast
  11450. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11451. @item ac
  11452. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11453. @end table
  11454. @subsection Examples
  11455. @itemize
  11456. @item
  11457. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11458. brightness/contrast:
  11459. @example
  11460. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11461. @end example
  11462. @item
  11463. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11464. @example
  11465. pp=de/-al
  11466. @end example
  11467. @item
  11468. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11469. @example
  11470. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11471. @end example
  11472. @item
  11473. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11474. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11475. @example
  11476. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11477. @end example
  11478. @end itemize
  11479. @section pp7
  11480. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11481. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11482. used after IDCT.
  11483. The filter accepts the following options:
  11484. @table @option
  11485. @item qp
  11486. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11487. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11488. (if available).
  11489. @item mode
  11490. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11491. @table @samp
  11492. @item hard
  11493. Set hard thresholding.
  11494. @item soft
  11495. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11496. @item medium
  11497. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11498. @end table
  11499. @end table
  11500. @section premultiply
  11501. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11502. of second stream as alpha.
  11503. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11504. The filter accepts the following option:
  11505. @table @option
  11506. @item planes
  11507. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11508. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11509. @item inplace
  11510. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11511. @end table
  11512. @section prewitt
  11513. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11514. The filter accepts the following option:
  11515. @table @option
  11516. @item planes
  11517. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11518. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11519. @item scale
  11520. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11521. @item delta
  11522. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11523. @end table
  11524. @section pseudocolor
  11525. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11526. This filter accepts the following options:
  11527. @table @option
  11528. @item c0
  11529. set pixel first component expression
  11530. @item c1
  11531. set pixel second component expression
  11532. @item c2
  11533. set pixel third component expression
  11534. @item c3
  11535. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11536. @item i
  11537. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11538. @end table
  11539. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11540. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11541. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11542. @table @option
  11543. @item w
  11544. @item h
  11545. The input width and height.
  11546. @item val
  11547. The input value for the pixel component.
  11548. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11549. The minimum allowed component value.
  11550. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11551. The maximum allowed component value.
  11552. @end table
  11553. All expressions default to "val".
  11554. @subsection Examples
  11555. @itemize
  11556. @item
  11557. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11558. @example
  11559. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11560. @end example
  11561. @end itemize
  11562. @section psnr
  11563. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11564. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11565. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11566. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11567. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11568. the PSNR.
  11569. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11570. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11571. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11572. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11573. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11574. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11575. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11576. @example
  11577. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11578. @end example
  11579. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11580. image.
  11581. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11582. @table @option
  11583. @item stats_file, f
  11584. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11585. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11586. standard output.
  11587. @item stats_version
  11588. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11589. each format are written below.
  11590. Default value is 1.
  11591. @item stats_add_max
  11592. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11593. Default value is 0.
  11594. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11595. the filter will return an error.
  11596. @end table
  11597. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11598. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11599. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11600. couple of frames.
  11601. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11602. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11603. format with the following parameters:
  11604. @table @option
  11605. @item psnr_log_version
  11606. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11607. @item fields
  11608. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11609. the log.
  11610. @end table
  11611. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11612. @table @option
  11613. @item n
  11614. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11615. @item mse_avg
  11616. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11617. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11618. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11619. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11620. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11621. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11622. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11623. specified by the suffix.
  11624. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11625. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11626. channels.
  11627. @end table
  11628. @subsection Examples
  11629. @itemize
  11630. @item
  11631. For example:
  11632. @example
  11633. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11634. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11635. @end example
  11636. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11637. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11638. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11639. @item
  11640. Another example with different containers:
  11641. @example
  11642. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -
  11643. @end example
  11644. @end itemize
  11645. @anchor{pullup}
  11646. @section pullup
  11647. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11648. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11649. content.
  11650. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11651. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11652. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11653. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11654. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11655. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11656. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11657. The filter accepts the following options:
  11658. @table @option
  11659. @item jl
  11660. @item jr
  11661. @item jt
  11662. @item jb
  11663. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11664. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11665. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11666. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11667. @item sb
  11668. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11669. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11670. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11671. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11672. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11673. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11674. Default value is @code{0}.
  11675. @item mp
  11676. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11677. @table @samp
  11678. @item l
  11679. Use luma plane.
  11680. @item u
  11681. Use chroma blue plane.
  11682. @item v
  11683. Use chroma red plane.
  11684. @end table
  11685. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11686. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11687. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11688. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11689. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11690. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11691. @end table
  11692. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11693. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11694. telecine NTSC input:
  11695. @example
  11696. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11697. @end example
  11698. @section qp
  11699. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11700. The filter accepts the following option:
  11701. @table @option
  11702. @item qp
  11703. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11704. @end table
  11705. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11706. the following constants:
  11707. @table @var
  11708. @item known
  11709. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11710. @item qp
  11711. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11712. @end table
  11713. @subsection Examples
  11714. @itemize
  11715. @item
  11716. Some equation like:
  11717. @example
  11718. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11719. @end example
  11720. @end itemize
  11721. @section random
  11722. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11723. No frame is discarded.
  11724. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11725. @table @option
  11726. @item frames
  11727. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11728. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11729. @item seed
  11730. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11731. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11732. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11733. best effort basis.
  11734. @end table
  11735. @section readeia608
  11736. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11737. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11738. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11739. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11740. @table @option
  11741. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11742. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11743. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11744. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11745. @end table
  11746. This filter accepts the following options:
  11747. @table @option
  11748. @item scan_min
  11749. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11750. @item scan_max
  11751. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11752. @item spw
  11753. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11754. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 0.7]}.
  11755. @item chp
  11756. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11757. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11758. @item lp
  11759. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is enabled.
  11760. @end table
  11761. @subsection Examples
  11762. @itemize
  11763. @item
  11764. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11765. @example
  11766. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11767. @end example
  11768. @end itemize
  11769. @section readvitc
  11770. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11771. video frame.
  11772. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11773. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11774. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11775. timecode data has been found or not.
  11776. This filter accepts the following options:
  11777. @table @option
  11778. @item scan_max
  11779. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11780. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11781. @item thr_b
  11782. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11783. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11784. @item thr_w
  11785. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11786. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11787. @end table
  11788. @subsection Examples
  11789. @itemize
  11790. @item
  11791. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11792. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11793. @example
  11794. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11795. @end example
  11796. @end itemize
  11797. @section remap
  11798. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11799. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11800. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11801. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11802. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11803. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11804. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11805. @table @option
  11806. @item format
  11807. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11808. Default is @code{color}.
  11809. @item fill
  11810. Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option,
  11811. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11812. manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default color is @code{black}.
  11813. @end table
  11814. @section removegrain
  11815. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11816. @table @option
  11817. @item m0
  11818. Set mode for the first plane.
  11819. @item m1
  11820. Set mode for the second plane.
  11821. @item m2
  11822. Set mode for the third plane.
  11823. @item m3
  11824. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11825. @end table
  11826. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11827. @table @var
  11828. @item 0
  11829. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11830. @item 1
  11831. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11832. @item 2
  11833. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11834. @item 3
  11835. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11836. @item 4
  11837. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11838. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11839. @item 5
  11840. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11841. @item 6
  11842. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11843. @item 7
  11844. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11845. @item 8
  11846. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11847. @item 9
  11848. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  11849. @item 10
  11850. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  11851. @item 11
  11852. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  11853. @item 12
  11854. Same as mode 11.
  11855. @item 13
  11856. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  11857. pixels are the closest.
  11858. @item 14
  11859. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  11860. pixels are the closest.
  11861. @item 15
  11862. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  11863. interpolation formula.
  11864. @item 16
  11865. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  11866. interpolation formula.
  11867. @item 17
  11868. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  11869. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  11870. @item 18
  11871. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  11872. the current pixel is minimal.
  11873. @item 19
  11874. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  11875. @item 20
  11876. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  11877. @item 21
  11878. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  11879. @item 22
  11880. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  11881. @item 23
  11882. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  11883. @item 24
  11884. Similar as 23.
  11885. @end table
  11886. @section removelogo
  11887. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  11888. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  11889. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  11890. The filter accepts the following options:
  11891. @table @option
  11892. @item filename, f
  11893. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  11894. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  11895. video stream being processed.
  11896. @end table
  11897. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  11898. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  11899. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  11900. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  11901. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  11902. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  11903. filter once or twice.
  11904. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  11905. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  11906. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  11907. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  11908. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  11909. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  11910. @section repeatfields
  11911. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  11912. fields based on its value.
  11913. @section reverse
  11914. Reverse a video clip.
  11915. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  11916. is suggested.
  11917. @subsection Examples
  11918. @itemize
  11919. @item
  11920. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  11921. @example
  11922. trim=end=5,reverse
  11923. @end example
  11924. @end itemize
  11925. @section rgbashift
  11926. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  11927. The filter accepts the following options:
  11928. @table @option
  11929. @item rh
  11930. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  11931. @item rv
  11932. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  11933. @item gh
  11934. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  11935. @item gv
  11936. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  11937. @item bh
  11938. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  11939. @item bv
  11940. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  11941. @item ah
  11942. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  11943. @item av
  11944. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  11945. @item edge
  11946. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  11947. @end table
  11948. @subsection Commands
  11949. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  11950. @section roberts
  11951. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  11952. The filter accepts the following option:
  11953. @table @option
  11954. @item planes
  11955. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11956. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11957. @item scale
  11958. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11959. @item delta
  11960. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11961. @end table
  11962. @section rotate
  11963. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  11964. The filter accepts the following options:
  11965. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  11966. @table @option
  11967. @item angle, a
  11968. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  11969. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  11970. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  11971. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  11972. @item out_w, ow
  11973. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  11974. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11975. @item out_h, oh
  11976. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  11977. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11978. @item bilinear
  11979. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  11980. it. Default value is 1.
  11981. @item fillcolor, c
  11982. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  11983. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  11984. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11985. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  11986. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  11987. Default value is "black".
  11988. @end table
  11989. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  11990. following constants and functions:
  11991. @table @option
  11992. @item n
  11993. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  11994. before the first frame is filtered.
  11995. @item t
  11996. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  11997. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  11998. @item hsub
  11999. @item vsub
  12000. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12001. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12002. @item in_w, iw
  12003. @item in_h, ih
  12004. the input video width and height
  12005. @item out_w, ow
  12006. @item out_h, oh
  12007. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  12008. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  12009. @item rotw(a)
  12010. @item roth(a)
  12011. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  12012. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  12013. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  12014. @option{out_h} expressions.
  12015. @end table
  12016. @subsection Examples
  12017. @itemize
  12018. @item
  12019. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  12020. @example
  12021. rotate=PI/6
  12022. @end example
  12023. @item
  12024. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  12025. @example
  12026. rotate=-PI/6
  12027. @end example
  12028. @item
  12029. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  12030. @example
  12031. rotate=45*PI/180
  12032. @end example
  12033. @item
  12034. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  12035. @example
  12036. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  12037. @end example
  12038. @item
  12039. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  12040. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  12041. @example
  12042. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  12043. @end example
  12044. @item
  12045. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  12046. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  12047. @example
  12048. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  12049. @end example
  12050. @item
  12051. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  12052. shown:
  12053. @example
  12054. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  12055. @end example
  12056. @end itemize
  12057. @subsection Commands
  12058. The filter supports the following commands:
  12059. @table @option
  12060. @item a, angle
  12061. Set the angle expression.
  12062. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12063. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12064. value.
  12065. @end table
  12066. @section sab
  12067. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  12068. The filter accepts the following options:
  12069. @table @option
  12070. @item luma_radius, lr
  12071. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  12072. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  12073. in slower processing.
  12074. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  12075. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  12076. value is 1.0.
  12077. @item luma_strength, ls
  12078. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  12079. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  12080. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12081. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  12082. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  12083. processing.
  12084. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  12085. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  12086. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12087. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  12088. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  12089. @end table
  12090. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  12091. corresponding luma option value.
  12092. @anchor{scale}
  12093. @section scale
  12094. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  12095. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  12096. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  12097. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  12098. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  12099. requested format.
  12100. @subsection Options
  12101. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  12102. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  12103. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  12104. the complete list of scaler options.
  12105. @table @option
  12106. @item width, w
  12107. @item height, h
  12108. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  12109. dimension.
  12110. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  12111. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  12112. is used for the output.
  12113. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  12114. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  12115. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  12116. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  12117. adjust the value if necessary.
  12118. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  12119. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  12120. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  12121. expression.
  12122. @item eval
  12123. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  12124. @table @samp
  12125. @item init
  12126. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  12127. @item frame
  12128. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  12129. @end table
  12130. Default value is @samp{init}.
  12131. @item interl
  12132. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  12133. @table @samp
  12134. @item 1
  12135. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  12136. @item 0
  12137. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  12138. @item -1
  12139. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  12140. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  12141. @end table
  12142. Default value is @samp{0}.
  12143. @item flags
  12144. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  12145. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12146. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12147. the default flags.
  12148. @item param0, param1
  12149. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  12150. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12151. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12152. empty parameters.
  12153. @item size, s
  12154. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12155. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12156. @item in_color_matrix
  12157. @item out_color_matrix
  12158. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  12159. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12160. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  12161. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  12162. Possible values:
  12163. @table @samp
  12164. @item auto
  12165. Choose automatically.
  12166. @item bt709
  12167. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  12168. Recommendation BT.709.
  12169. @item fcc
  12170. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  12171. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  12172. @item bt601
  12173. @item bt470
  12174. @item smpte170m
  12175. Set color space conforming to:
  12176. @itemize
  12177. @item
  12178. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  12179. @item
  12180. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  12181. @item
  12182. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  12183. @end itemize
  12184. @item smpte240m
  12185. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  12186. @item bt2020
  12187. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  12188. @end table
  12189. @item in_range
  12190. @item out_range
  12191. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  12192. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12193. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  12194. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  12195. @table @samp
  12196. @item auto/unknown
  12197. Choose automatically.
  12198. @item jpeg/full/pc
  12199. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12200. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  12201. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12202. @end table
  12203. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12204. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12205. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12206. @table @samp
  12207. @item disable
  12208. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12209. @item decrease
  12210. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12211. @item increase
  12212. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12213. @end table
  12214. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12215. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12216. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12217. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12218. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12219. 1280x533.
  12220. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12221. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12222. to work.
  12223. @item force_divisible_by
  12224. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12225. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12226. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12227. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12228. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12229. may be slightly modified.
  12230. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12231. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12232. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12233. @end table
  12234. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  12235. containing the following constants:
  12236. @table @var
  12237. @item in_w
  12238. @item in_h
  12239. The input width and height
  12240. @item iw
  12241. @item ih
  12242. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  12243. @item out_w
  12244. @item out_h
  12245. The output (scaled) width and height
  12246. @item ow
  12247. @item oh
  12248. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  12249. @item a
  12250. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  12251. @item sar
  12252. input sample aspect ratio
  12253. @item dar
  12254. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  12255. @item hsub
  12256. @item vsub
  12257. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12258. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12259. @item ohsub
  12260. @item ovsub
  12261. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12262. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12263. @item n
  12264. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12265. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12266. @item t
  12267. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12268. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12269. @item pos
  12270. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the input stream, or NaN if
  12271. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12272. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12273. @end table
  12274. @subsection Examples
  12275. @itemize
  12276. @item
  12277. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  12278. @example
  12279. scale=w=200:h=100
  12280. @end example
  12281. This is equivalent to:
  12282. @example
  12283. scale=200:100
  12284. @end example
  12285. or:
  12286. @example
  12287. scale=200x100
  12288. @end example
  12289. @item
  12290. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  12291. @example
  12292. scale=qcif
  12293. @end example
  12294. which can also be written as:
  12295. @example
  12296. scale=size=qcif
  12297. @end example
  12298. @item
  12299. Scale the input to 2x:
  12300. @example
  12301. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  12302. @end example
  12303. @item
  12304. The above is the same as:
  12305. @example
  12306. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  12307. @end example
  12308. @item
  12309. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  12310. @example
  12311. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  12312. @end example
  12313. @item
  12314. Scale the input to half size:
  12315. @example
  12316. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  12317. @end example
  12318. @item
  12319. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  12320. @example
  12321. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  12322. @end example
  12323. @item
  12324. Seek Greek harmony:
  12325. @example
  12326. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  12327. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  12328. @end example
  12329. @item
  12330. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  12331. @example
  12332. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  12333. @end example
  12334. @item
  12335. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12336. subsample values:
  12337. @example
  12338. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12339. @end example
  12340. @item
  12341. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12342. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12343. @example
  12344. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12345. @end example
  12346. @item
  12347. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12348. @example
  12349. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12350. @end example
  12351. @item
  12352. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12353. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12354. @example
  12355. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12356. @end example
  12357. @end itemize
  12358. @subsection Commands
  12359. This filter supports the following commands:
  12360. @table @option
  12361. @item width, w
  12362. @item height, h
  12363. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12364. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12365. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12366. value.
  12367. @end table
  12368. @section scale_npp
  12369. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12370. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12371. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12372. The following additional options are accepted:
  12373. @table @option
  12374. @item format
  12375. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12376. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12377. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12378. @item interp_algo
  12379. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12380. @table @option
  12381. @item nn
  12382. Nearest neighbour.
  12383. @item linear
  12384. @item cubic
  12385. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12386. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12387. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12388. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12389. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12390. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12391. @item super
  12392. Supersampling
  12393. @item lanczos
  12394. @end table
  12395. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12396. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12397. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12398. @table @samp
  12399. @item disable
  12400. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12401. @item decrease
  12402. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12403. @item increase
  12404. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12405. @end table
  12406. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12407. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12408. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12409. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12410. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12411. 1280x533.
  12412. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12413. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12414. to work.
  12415. @item force_divisible_by
  12416. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12417. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12418. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12419. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12420. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12421. may be slightly modified.
  12422. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12423. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12424. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12425. @end table
  12426. @section scale2ref
  12427. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12428. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12429. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12430. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12431. @option{h} options:
  12432. @table @var
  12433. @item main_w
  12434. @item main_h
  12435. The main input video's width and height
  12436. @item main_a
  12437. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12438. @item main_sar
  12439. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12440. @item main_dar, mdar
  12441. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12442. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12443. @item main_hsub
  12444. @item main_vsub
  12445. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12446. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12447. is 1.
  12448. @item main_n
  12449. The (sequential) number of the main input frame, starting from 0.
  12450. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12451. @item main_t
  12452. The presentation timestamp of the main input frame, expressed as a number of
  12453. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12454. @item main_pos
  12455. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the main input stream, or NaN if
  12456. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12457. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12458. @end table
  12459. @subsection Examples
  12460. @itemize
  12461. @item
  12462. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12463. @example
  12464. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12465. @end example
  12466. @item
  12467. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12468. @example
  12469. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12470. @end example
  12471. @end itemize
  12472. @subsection Commands
  12473. This filter supports the following commands:
  12474. @table @option
  12475. @item width, w
  12476. @item height, h
  12477. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12478. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12479. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12480. value.
  12481. @end table
  12482. @section scroll
  12483. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12484. The filter accepts the following options:
  12485. @table @option
  12486. @item horizontal, h
  12487. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12488. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12489. @item vertical, v
  12490. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12491. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12492. @item hpos
  12493. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12494. @item vpos
  12495. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12496. @end table
  12497. @subsection Commands
  12498. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12499. @table @option
  12500. @item horizontal, h
  12501. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12502. @item vertical, v
  12503. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12504. @end table
  12505. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12506. @section selectivecolor
  12507. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12508. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12509. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12510. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12511. The filter accepts the following options:
  12512. @table @option
  12513. @item correction_method
  12514. Select color correction method.
  12515. Available values are:
  12516. @table @samp
  12517. @item absolute
  12518. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12519. component value).
  12520. @item relative
  12521. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12522. @end table
  12523. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12524. @item reds
  12525. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12526. @item yellows
  12527. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12528. @item greens
  12529. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12530. @item cyans
  12531. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12532. @item blues
  12533. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12534. @item magentas
  12535. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12536. @item whites
  12537. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12538. @item neutrals
  12539. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12540. @item blacks
  12541. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12542. @item psfile
  12543. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12544. @end table
  12545. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12546. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12547. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12548. pixels of its range.
  12549. @subsection Examples
  12550. @itemize
  12551. @item
  12552. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12553. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12554. @example
  12555. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12556. @end example
  12557. @item
  12558. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12559. @example
  12560. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12561. @end example
  12562. @end itemize
  12563. @anchor{separatefields}
  12564. @section separatefields
  12565. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12566. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12567. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12568. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12569. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12570. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12571. @section setdar, setsar
  12572. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12573. output video.
  12574. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12575. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12576. @example
  12577. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12578. @end example
  12579. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12580. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12581. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12582. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12583. applied.
  12584. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12585. the filter output video.
  12586. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12587. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12588. above.
  12589. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12590. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12591. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12592. It accepts the following parameters:
  12593. @table @option
  12594. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12595. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12596. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12597. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12598. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12599. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12600. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12601. should be escaped.
  12602. @item max
  12603. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12604. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12605. Default value is @code{100}.
  12606. @end table
  12607. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12608. the following constants:
  12609. @table @option
  12610. @item E, PI, PHI
  12611. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12612. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12613. @item w, h
  12614. The input width and height.
  12615. @item a
  12616. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12617. @item sar
  12618. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12619. @item dar
  12620. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12621. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12622. @item hsub, vsub
  12623. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12624. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12625. @end table
  12626. @subsection Examples
  12627. @itemize
  12628. @item
  12629. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12630. @example
  12631. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12632. setdar=dar=16/9
  12633. @end example
  12634. @item
  12635. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12636. @example
  12637. setsar=sar=10/11
  12638. @end example
  12639. @item
  12640. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12641. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12642. @example
  12643. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12644. @end example
  12645. @end itemize
  12646. @anchor{setfield}
  12647. @section setfield
  12648. Force field for the output video frame.
  12649. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12650. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12651. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12652. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12653. The filter accepts the following options:
  12654. @table @option
  12655. @item mode
  12656. Available values are:
  12657. @table @samp
  12658. @item auto
  12659. Keep the same field property.
  12660. @item bff
  12661. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12662. @item tff
  12663. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12664. @item prog
  12665. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12666. @end table
  12667. @end table
  12668. @anchor{setparams}
  12669. @section setparams
  12670. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12671. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12672. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12673. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12674. filters/encoders.
  12675. @table @option
  12676. @item field_mode
  12677. Available values are:
  12678. @table @samp
  12679. @item auto
  12680. Keep the same field property (default).
  12681. @item bff
  12682. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12683. @item tff
  12684. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12685. @item prog
  12686. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12687. @end table
  12688. @item range
  12689. Available values are:
  12690. @table @samp
  12691. @item auto
  12692. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12693. @item unspecified, unknown
  12694. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12695. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12696. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12697. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12698. Mark the frame as full range.
  12699. @end table
  12700. @item color_primaries
  12701. Set the color primaries.
  12702. Available values are:
  12703. @table @samp
  12704. @item auto
  12705. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12706. @item bt709
  12707. @item unknown
  12708. @item bt470m
  12709. @item bt470bg
  12710. @item smpte170m
  12711. @item smpte240m
  12712. @item film
  12713. @item bt2020
  12714. @item smpte428
  12715. @item smpte431
  12716. @item smpte432
  12717. @item jedec-p22
  12718. @end table
  12719. @item color_trc
  12720. Set the color transfer.
  12721. Available values are:
  12722. @table @samp
  12723. @item auto
  12724. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12725. @item bt709
  12726. @item unknown
  12727. @item bt470m
  12728. @item bt470bg
  12729. @item smpte170m
  12730. @item smpte240m
  12731. @item linear
  12732. @item log100
  12733. @item log316
  12734. @item iec61966-2-4
  12735. @item bt1361e
  12736. @item iec61966-2-1
  12737. @item bt2020-10
  12738. @item bt2020-12
  12739. @item smpte2084
  12740. @item smpte428
  12741. @item arib-std-b67
  12742. @end table
  12743. @item colorspace
  12744. Set the colorspace.
  12745. Available values are:
  12746. @table @samp
  12747. @item auto
  12748. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12749. @item gbr
  12750. @item bt709
  12751. @item unknown
  12752. @item fcc
  12753. @item bt470bg
  12754. @item smpte170m
  12755. @item smpte240m
  12756. @item ycgco
  12757. @item bt2020nc
  12758. @item bt2020c
  12759. @item smpte2085
  12760. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12761. @item chroma-derived-c
  12762. @item ictcp
  12763. @end table
  12764. @end table
  12765. @section showinfo
  12766. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12767. The input video is not modified.
  12768. This filter supports the following options:
  12769. @table @option
  12770. @item checksum
  12771. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12772. @end table
  12773. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12774. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12775. The following values are shown in the output:
  12776. @table @option
  12777. @item n
  12778. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12779. @item pts
  12780. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12781. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12782. @item pts_time
  12783. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12784. seconds.
  12785. @item pos
  12786. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12787. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12788. @item fmt
  12789. The pixel format name.
  12790. @item sar
  12791. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12792. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12793. @item s
  12794. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12795. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12796. @item i
  12797. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12798. for bottom field first).
  12799. @item iskey
  12800. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12801. @item type
  12802. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12803. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12804. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12805. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12806. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12807. @item checksum
  12808. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12809. @item plane_checksum
  12810. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12811. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12812. @item mean
  12813. The mean value of pixels in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12814. "[@var{mean0} @var{mean1} @var{mean2} @var{mean3}]".
  12815. @item stdev
  12816. The standard deviation of pixel values in each plane of the input frame, expressed
  12817. in the form "[@var{stdev0} @var{stdev1} @var{stdev2} @var{stdev3}]".
  12818. @end table
  12819. @section showpalette
  12820. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12821. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12822. It accepts the following option:
  12823. @table @option
  12824. @item s
  12825. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  12826. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  12827. @end table
  12828. @section shuffleframes
  12829. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  12830. It accepts the following parameters:
  12831. @table @option
  12832. @item mapping
  12833. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  12834. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  12835. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  12836. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  12837. @end table
  12838. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12839. @subsection Examples
  12840. @itemize
  12841. @item
  12842. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  12843. @example
  12844. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  12845. @end example
  12846. @item
  12847. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  12848. @example
  12849. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  12850. @end example
  12851. @end itemize
  12852. @section shuffleplanes
  12853. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  12854. It accepts the following parameters:
  12855. @table @option
  12856. @item map0
  12857. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  12858. @item map1
  12859. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  12860. @item map2
  12861. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  12862. @item map3
  12863. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  12864. @end table
  12865. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12866. @subsection Examples
  12867. @itemize
  12868. @item
  12869. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  12870. @example
  12871. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  12872. @end example
  12873. @end itemize
  12874. @anchor{signalstats}
  12875. @section signalstats
  12876. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  12877. with the digitization of analog video media.
  12878. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  12879. @table @option
  12880. @item YMIN
  12881. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12882. range of [0-255].
  12883. @item YLOW
  12884. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12885. range of [0-255].
  12886. @item YAVG
  12887. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12888. [0-255].
  12889. @item YHIGH
  12890. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12891. range of [0-255].
  12892. @item YMAX
  12893. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12894. range of [0-255].
  12895. @item UMIN
  12896. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12897. range of [0-255].
  12898. @item ULOW
  12899. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12900. range of [0-255].
  12901. @item UAVG
  12902. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12903. [0-255].
  12904. @item UHIGH
  12905. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12906. range of [0-255].
  12907. @item UMAX
  12908. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12909. range of [0-255].
  12910. @item VMIN
  12911. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12912. range of [0-255].
  12913. @item VLOW
  12914. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12915. range of [0-255].
  12916. @item VAVG
  12917. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12918. [0-255].
  12919. @item VHIGH
  12920. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12921. range of [0-255].
  12922. @item VMAX
  12923. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12924. range of [0-255].
  12925. @item SATMIN
  12926. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12927. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12928. @item SATLOW
  12929. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  12930. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12931. @item SATAVG
  12932. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  12933. of [0-~181.02].
  12934. @item SATHIGH
  12935. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  12936. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12937. @item SATMAX
  12938. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12939. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12940. @item HUEMED
  12941. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12942. [0-360].
  12943. @item HUEAVG
  12944. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12945. [0-360].
  12946. @item YDIF
  12947. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  12948. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12949. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12950. @item UDIF
  12951. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  12952. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12953. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12954. @item VDIF
  12955. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  12956. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12957. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12958. @item YBITDEPTH
  12959. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  12960. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12961. @item UBITDEPTH
  12962. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  12963. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12964. @item VBITDEPTH
  12965. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  12966. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12967. @end table
  12968. The filter accepts the following options:
  12969. @table @option
  12970. @item stat
  12971. @item out
  12972. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  12973. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  12974. Both options accept the following values:
  12975. @table @samp
  12976. @item tout
  12977. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  12978. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  12979. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  12980. @item vrep
  12981. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  12982. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  12983. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  12984. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  12985. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  12986. @item brng
  12987. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  12988. @end table
  12989. @item color, c
  12990. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  12991. yellow.
  12992. @end table
  12993. @subsection Examples
  12994. @itemize
  12995. @item
  12996. Output data of various video metrics:
  12997. @example
  12998. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  12999. @end example
  13000. @item
  13001. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  13002. @example
  13003. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  13004. @end example
  13005. @item
  13006. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  13007. @example
  13008. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  13009. @end example
  13010. @item
  13011. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  13012. @example
  13013. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  13014. @end example
  13015. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  13016. @example
  13017. time %@{pts:hms@}
  13018. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  13019. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  13020. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  13021. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  13022. @end example
  13023. @end itemize
  13024. @anchor{signature}
  13025. @section signature
  13026. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  13027. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  13028. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  13029. be written into a file.
  13030. It accepts the following options:
  13031. @table @option
  13032. @item detectmode
  13033. Enable or disable the matching process.
  13034. Available values are:
  13035. @table @samp
  13036. @item off
  13037. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  13038. @item full
  13039. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  13040. matches or only parts.
  13041. @item fast
  13042. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  13043. some cases.
  13044. @end table
  13045. @item nb_inputs
  13046. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  13047. Default value is 1.
  13048. @item filename
  13049. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  13050. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  13051. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  13052. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  13053. @item format
  13054. Choose the output format.
  13055. Available values are:
  13056. @table @samp
  13057. @item binary
  13058. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  13059. @item xml
  13060. Use the specified xml representation.
  13061. @end table
  13062. @item th_d
  13063. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13064. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  13065. @item th_dc
  13066. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13067. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  13068. @item th_xh
  13069. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13070. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  13071. @item th_di
  13072. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  13073. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  13074. The default value is 0.
  13075. @item th_it
  13076. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  13077. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  13078. @end table
  13079. @subsection Examples
  13080. @itemize
  13081. @item
  13082. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  13083. @example
  13084. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  13085. @end example
  13086. @item
  13087. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  13088. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  13089. @example
  13090. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  13091. @end example
  13092. @end itemize
  13093. @anchor{smartblur}
  13094. @section smartblur
  13095. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  13096. It accepts the following options:
  13097. @table @option
  13098. @item luma_radius, lr
  13099. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13100. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13101. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  13102. @item luma_strength, ls
  13103. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13104. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13105. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13106. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  13107. @item luma_threshold, lt
  13108. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13109. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13110. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13111. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13112. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  13113. @item chroma_radius, cr
  13114. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13115. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13116. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  13117. @item chroma_strength, cs
  13118. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13119. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13120. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13121. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  13122. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  13123. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13124. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13125. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13126. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13127. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  13128. @end table
  13129. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  13130. is set.
  13131. @section sobel
  13132. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  13133. The filter accepts the following option:
  13134. @table @option
  13135. @item planes
  13136. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13137. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13138. @item scale
  13139. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  13140. @item delta
  13141. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  13142. @end table
  13143. @anchor{spp}
  13144. @section spp
  13145. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  13146. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  13147. and average the results.
  13148. The filter accepts the following options:
  13149. @table @option
  13150. @item quality
  13151. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13152. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13153. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13154. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13155. @code{3}.
  13156. @item qp
  13157. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13158. from the video stream (if available).
  13159. @item mode
  13160. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  13161. @table @samp
  13162. @item hard
  13163. Set hard thresholding (default).
  13164. @item soft
  13165. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  13166. @end table
  13167. @item use_bframe_qp
  13168. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  13169. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  13170. @code{0} (not enabled).
  13171. @end table
  13172. @subsection Commands
  13173. This filter supports the following commands:
  13174. @table @option
  13175. @item quality, level
  13176. Set quality level. The value @code{max} can be used to set the maximum level,
  13177. currently @code{6}.
  13178. @end table
  13179. @section sr
  13180. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  13181. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  13182. @itemize
  13183. @item
  13184. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  13185. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  13186. @item
  13187. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  13188. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  13189. @end itemize
  13190. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  13191. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  13192. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  13193. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  13194. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  13195. The filter accepts the following options:
  13196. @table @option
  13197. @item dnn_backend
  13198. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  13199. the following values:
  13200. @table @samp
  13201. @item native
  13202. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  13203. @item tensorflow
  13204. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  13205. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  13206. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  13207. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  13208. @end table
  13209. Default value is @samp{native}.
  13210. @item model
  13211. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  13212. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  13213. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  13214. its format.
  13215. @item scale_factor
  13216. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  13217. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  13218. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  13219. @end table
  13220. @section ssim
  13221. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  13222. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  13223. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  13224. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  13225. the SSIM.
  13226. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  13227. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  13228. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  13229. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  13230. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  13231. @table @option
  13232. @item stats_file, f
  13233. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  13234. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  13235. standard output.
  13236. @end table
  13237. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  13238. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  13239. couple of frames.
  13240. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  13241. @table @option
  13242. @item n
  13243. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  13244. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  13245. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  13246. @item All
  13247. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  13248. @item dB
  13249. Same as above but in dB representation.
  13250. @end table
  13251. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  13252. @subsection Examples
  13253. @itemize
  13254. @item
  13255. For example:
  13256. @example
  13257. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13258. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  13259. @end example
  13260. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  13261. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  13262. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  13263. @item
  13264. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  13265. @example
  13266. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  13267. @end example
  13268. @item
  13269. Another example with different containers:
  13270. @example
  13271. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -
  13272. @end example
  13273. @end itemize
  13274. @section stereo3d
  13275. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  13276. The filters accept the following options:
  13277. @table @option
  13278. @item in
  13279. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  13280. Available values for input image formats are:
  13281. @table @samp
  13282. @item sbsl
  13283. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13284. @item sbsr
  13285. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13286. @item sbs2l
  13287. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13288. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13289. @item sbs2r
  13290. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13291. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13292. @item abl
  13293. @item tbl
  13294. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13295. @item abr
  13296. @item tbr
  13297. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13298. @item ab2l
  13299. @item tb2l
  13300. above-below with half height resolution
  13301. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13302. @item ab2r
  13303. @item tb2r
  13304. above-below with half height resolution
  13305. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13306. @item al
  13307. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13308. @item ar
  13309. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13310. @item irl
  13311. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13312. @item irr
  13313. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13314. @item icl
  13315. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13316. @item icr
  13317. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13318. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  13319. @end table
  13320. @item out
  13321. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  13322. @table @samp
  13323. @item sbsl
  13324. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13325. @item sbsr
  13326. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13327. @item sbs2l
  13328. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13329. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13330. @item sbs2r
  13331. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13332. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13333. @item abl
  13334. @item tbl
  13335. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13336. @item abr
  13337. @item tbr
  13338. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13339. @item ab2l
  13340. @item tb2l
  13341. above-below with half height resolution
  13342. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13343. @item ab2r
  13344. @item tb2r
  13345. above-below with half height resolution
  13346. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13347. @item al
  13348. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13349. @item ar
  13350. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13351. @item irl
  13352. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13353. @item irr
  13354. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13355. @item arbg
  13356. anaglyph red/blue gray
  13357. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13358. @item argg
  13359. anaglyph red/green gray
  13360. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  13361. @item arcg
  13362. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  13363. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13364. @item arch
  13365. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  13366. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13367. @item arcc
  13368. anaglyph red/cyan color
  13369. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13370. @item arcd
  13371. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13372. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13373. @item agmg
  13374. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  13375. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13376. @item agmh
  13377. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  13378. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13379. @item agmc
  13380. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  13381. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13382. @item agmd
  13383. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13384. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13385. @item aybg
  13386. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  13387. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13388. @item aybh
  13389. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  13390. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13391. @item aybc
  13392. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  13393. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13394. @item aybd
  13395. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13396. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13397. @item ml
  13398. mono output (left eye only)
  13399. @item mr
  13400. mono output (right eye only)
  13401. @item chl
  13402. checkerboard, left eye first
  13403. @item chr
  13404. checkerboard, right eye first
  13405. @item icl
  13406. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13407. @item icr
  13408. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13409. @item hdmi
  13410. HDMI frame pack
  13411. @end table
  13412. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13413. @end table
  13414. @subsection Examples
  13415. @itemize
  13416. @item
  13417. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13418. @example
  13419. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13420. @end example
  13421. @item
  13422. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13423. @example
  13424. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13425. @end example
  13426. @end itemize
  13427. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13428. Select video or audio streams.
  13429. The filter accepts the following options:
  13430. @table @option
  13431. @item inputs
  13432. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13433. @item map
  13434. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13435. @end table
  13436. @subsection Commands
  13437. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13438. commands:
  13439. @table @option
  13440. @item map
  13441. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13442. @end table
  13443. @subsection Examples
  13444. @itemize
  13445. @item
  13446. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13447. @example
  13448. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13449. @end example
  13450. @item
  13451. Same as above, but for audio:
  13452. @example
  13453. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13454. @end example
  13455. @end itemize
  13456. @anchor{subtitles}
  13457. @section subtitles
  13458. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13459. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13460. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13461. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13462. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13463. The filter accepts the following options:
  13464. @table @option
  13465. @item filename, f
  13466. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13467. @item original_size
  13468. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13469. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13470. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13471. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13472. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13473. @item fontsdir
  13474. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13475. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13476. @item alpha
  13477. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13478. @item charenc
  13479. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13480. useful if not UTF-8.
  13481. @item stream_index, si
  13482. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13483. @item force_style
  13484. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13485. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13486. @end table
  13487. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13488. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13489. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13490. video, use the command:
  13491. @example
  13492. subtitles=sub.srt
  13493. @end example
  13494. which is equivalent to:
  13495. @example
  13496. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13497. @end example
  13498. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13499. @example
  13500. subtitles=video.mkv
  13501. @end example
  13502. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13503. @example
  13504. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13505. @end example
  13506. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13507. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13508. @example
  13509. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13510. @end example
  13511. @section super2xsai
  13512. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13513. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13514. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13515. @section swaprect
  13516. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13517. This filter accepts the following options:
  13518. @table @option
  13519. @item w
  13520. Set object width.
  13521. @item h
  13522. Set object height.
  13523. @item x1
  13524. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13525. @item y1
  13526. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13527. @item x2
  13528. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13529. @item y2
  13530. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13531. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13532. @end table
  13533. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13534. @table @option
  13535. @item w
  13536. @item h
  13537. The input width and height.
  13538. @item a
  13539. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13540. @item sar
  13541. input sample aspect ratio
  13542. @item dar
  13543. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13544. @item n
  13545. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13546. @item t
  13547. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13548. @item pos
  13549. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13550. @end table
  13551. @section swapuv
  13552. Swap U & V plane.
  13553. @section telecine
  13554. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13555. This filter accepts the following options:
  13556. @table @option
  13557. @item first_field
  13558. @table @samp
  13559. @item top, t
  13560. top field first
  13561. @item bottom, b
  13562. bottom field first
  13563. The default value is @code{top}.
  13564. @end table
  13565. @item pattern
  13566. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13567. The default value is @code{23}.
  13568. @end table
  13569. @example
  13570. Some typical patterns:
  13571. NTSC output (30i):
  13572. 27.5p: 32222
  13573. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13574. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13575. 20p: 33
  13576. 18p: 334
  13577. 16p: 3444
  13578. PAL output (25i):
  13579. 27.5p: 12222
  13580. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13581. 16.67p: 33
  13582. 16p: 33333334
  13583. @end example
  13584. @section thistogram
  13585. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video across time.
  13586. Unlike @ref{histogram} video filter which only shows histogram of single input frame
  13587. at certain time, this filter shows also past histograms of number of frames defined
  13588. by @code{width} option.
  13589. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  13590. distribution in an image.
  13591. The filter accepts the following options:
  13592. @table @option
  13593. @item width, w
  13594. Set width of single color component output. Default value is @code{0}.
  13595. Value of @code{0} means width will be picked from input video.
  13596. This also set number of passed histograms to keep.
  13597. Allowed range is [0, 8192].
  13598. @item display_mode, d
  13599. Set display mode.
  13600. It accepts the following values:
  13601. @table @samp
  13602. @item stack
  13603. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  13604. @item parade
  13605. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  13606. @item overlay
  13607. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  13608. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  13609. over one another.
  13610. @end table
  13611. Default is @code{stack}.
  13612. @item levels_mode, m
  13613. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  13614. Default is @code{linear}.
  13615. @item components, c
  13616. Set what color components to display.
  13617. Default is @code{7}.
  13618. @item bgopacity, b
  13619. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.9}.
  13620. @item envelope, e
  13621. Show envelope. Default is disabled.
  13622. @item ecolor, ec
  13623. Set envelope color. Default is @code{gold}.
  13624. @end table
  13625. @section threshold
  13626. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13627. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13628. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13629. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13630. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13631. The filter accepts the following option:
  13632. @table @option
  13633. @item planes
  13634. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13635. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13636. @end table
  13637. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13638. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13639. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13640. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13641. @subsection Examples
  13642. @itemize
  13643. @item
  13644. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13645. @example
  13646. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13647. @end example
  13648. @item
  13649. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13650. @example
  13651. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13652. @end example
  13653. @item
  13654. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13655. @example
  13656. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13657. @end example
  13658. @item
  13659. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13660. @example
  13661. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13662. @end example
  13663. @item
  13664. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13665. @example
  13666. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13667. @end example
  13668. @end itemize
  13669. @section thumbnail
  13670. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13671. The filter accepts the following options:
  13672. @table @option
  13673. @item n
  13674. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13675. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13676. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13677. @end table
  13678. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13679. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13680. @subsection Examples
  13681. @itemize
  13682. @item
  13683. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13684. @example
  13685. thumbnail=50
  13686. @end example
  13687. @item
  13688. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13689. @example
  13690. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13691. @end example
  13692. @end itemize
  13693. @section tile
  13694. Tile several successive frames together.
  13695. The filter accepts the following options:
  13696. @table @option
  13697. @item layout
  13698. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13699. this option, check the
  13700. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13701. @item nb_frames
  13702. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13703. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13704. the area will be used.
  13705. @item margin
  13706. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13707. @item padding
  13708. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13709. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13710. refer to the pad video filter.
  13711. @item color
  13712. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13713. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13714. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13715. @item overlap
  13716. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13717. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13718. @item init_padding
  13719. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13720. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13721. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13722. @end table
  13723. @subsection Examples
  13724. @itemize
  13725. @item
  13726. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13727. @example
  13728. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13729. @end example
  13730. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13731. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13732. rate.
  13733. @item
  13734. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13735. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13736. mixed flat and named options:
  13737. @example
  13738. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13739. @end example
  13740. @end itemize
  13741. @section tinterlace
  13742. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13743. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13744. considered odd.
  13745. The filter accepts the following options:
  13746. @table @option
  13747. @item mode
  13748. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13749. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13750. Available values are:
  13751. @table @samp
  13752. @item merge, 0
  13753. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13754. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13755. @example
  13756. ------> time
  13757. Input:
  13758. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13759. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13760. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13761. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13762. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13763. Output:
  13764. 11111 33333
  13765. 22222 44444
  13766. 11111 33333
  13767. 22222 44444
  13768. 11111 33333
  13769. 22222 44444
  13770. 11111 33333
  13771. 22222 44444
  13772. @end example
  13773. @item drop_even, 1
  13774. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13775. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13776. @example
  13777. ------> time
  13778. Input:
  13779. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13780. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13781. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13782. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13783. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13784. Output:
  13785. 11111 33333
  13786. 11111 33333
  13787. 11111 33333
  13788. 11111 33333
  13789. @end example
  13790. @item drop_odd, 2
  13791. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13792. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13793. @example
  13794. ------> time
  13795. Input:
  13796. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13797. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13798. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13799. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13800. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13801. Output:
  13802. 22222 44444
  13803. 22222 44444
  13804. 22222 44444
  13805. 22222 44444
  13806. @end example
  13807. @item pad, 3
  13808. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13809. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13810. @example
  13811. ------> time
  13812. Input:
  13813. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13814. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13815. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13816. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13817. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13818. Output:
  13819. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13820. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13821. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13822. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13823. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13824. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13825. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13826. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13827. @end example
  13828. @item interleave_top, 4
  13829. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  13830. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13831. @example
  13832. ------> time
  13833. Input:
  13834. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13835. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13836. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13837. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13838. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13839. Output:
  13840. 11111 33333
  13841. 22222 44444
  13842. 11111 33333
  13843. 22222 44444
  13844. @end example
  13845. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  13846. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  13847. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13848. @example
  13849. ------> time
  13850. Input:
  13851. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13852. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13853. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13854. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13855. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13856. Output:
  13857. 22222 44444
  13858. 11111 33333
  13859. 22222 44444
  13860. 11111 33333
  13861. @end example
  13862. @item interlacex2, 6
  13863. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  13864. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  13865. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  13866. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  13867. field synchronisation.
  13868. @example
  13869. ------> time
  13870. Input:
  13871. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13872. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13873. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13874. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13875. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13876. Output:
  13877. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13878. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13879. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13880. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13881. @end example
  13882. @item mergex2, 7
  13883. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13884. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  13885. @example
  13886. ------> time
  13887. Input:
  13888. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13889. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13890. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13891. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13892. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13893. Output:
  13894. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13895. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13896. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13897. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13898. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13899. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13900. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13901. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13902. @end example
  13903. @end table
  13904. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  13905. compatibility reasons.
  13906. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  13907. @item flags
  13908. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  13909. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  13910. @table @option
  13911. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  13912. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  13913. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  13914. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  13915. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13916. patterning.
  13917. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  13918. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  13919. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13920. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  13921. @item bypass_il
  13922. Bypass already interlaced frames, only adjust the frame rate.
  13923. @end table
  13924. Vertical low-pass filtering and bypassing already interlaced frames can only be
  13925. enabled for @option{mode} @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  13926. @end table
  13927. @section tmix
  13928. Mix successive video frames.
  13929. A description of the accepted options follows.
  13930. @table @option
  13931. @item frames
  13932. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  13933. @item weights
  13934. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  13935. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  13936. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  13937. unset weights.
  13938. @item scale
  13939. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  13940. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  13941. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  13942. @end table
  13943. @subsection Examples
  13944. @itemize
  13945. @item
  13946. Average 7 successive frames:
  13947. @example
  13948. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  13949. @end example
  13950. @item
  13951. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  13952. @example
  13953. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  13954. @end example
  13955. @item
  13956. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  13957. @example
  13958. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  13959. @end example
  13960. @end itemize
  13961. @anchor{tonemap}
  13962. @section tonemap
  13963. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  13964. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  13965. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  13966. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  13967. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  13968. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  13969. @example
  13970. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  13971. @end example
  13972. @subsection Options
  13973. The filter accepts the following options.
  13974. @table @option
  13975. @item tonemap
  13976. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  13977. Possible values are:
  13978. @table @var
  13979. @item none
  13980. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  13981. @item clip
  13982. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  13983. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  13984. @item linear
  13985. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  13986. @item gamma
  13987. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  13988. @item reinhard
  13989. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  13990. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  13991. @item hable
  13992. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  13993. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  13994. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  13995. @item mobius
  13996. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  13997. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  13998. important than detail preservation.
  13999. @end table
  14000. Default is none.
  14001. @item param
  14002. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  14003. This affects the following algorithms:
  14004. @table @var
  14005. @item none
  14006. Ignored.
  14007. @item linear
  14008. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  14009. Default to 1.0.
  14010. @item gamma
  14011. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  14012. Default to 1.8.
  14013. @item clip
  14014. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  14015. Default to 1.0.
  14016. @item reinhard
  14017. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  14018. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  14019. as when clipping.
  14020. @item hable
  14021. Ignored.
  14022. @item mobius
  14023. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  14024. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  14025. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  14026. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  14027. colors fairly accurately.
  14028. @end table
  14029. @item desat
  14030. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  14031. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  14032. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  14033. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  14034. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  14035. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  14036. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  14037. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  14038. @item peak
  14039. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  14040. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  14041. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  14042. @end table
  14043. @section tpad
  14044. Temporarily pad video frames.
  14045. The filter accepts the following options:
  14046. @table @option
  14047. @item start
  14048. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream.
  14049. @item stop
  14050. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  14051. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely.
  14052. @item start_mode
  14053. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  14054. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14055. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14056. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  14057. @item stop_mode
  14058. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  14059. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14060. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14061. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  14062. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  14063. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  14064. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14065. for the accepted syntax.
  14066. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}.
  14067. @item color
  14068. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  14069. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  14070. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14071. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  14072. @end table
  14073. @anchor{transpose}
  14074. @section transpose
  14075. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14076. It accepts the following parameters:
  14077. @table @option
  14078. @item dir
  14079. Specify the transposition direction.
  14080. Can assume the following values:
  14081. @table @samp
  14082. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  14083. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  14084. @example
  14085. L.R L.l
  14086. . . -> . .
  14087. l.r R.r
  14088. @end example
  14089. @item 1, 5, clock
  14090. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  14091. @example
  14092. L.R l.L
  14093. . . -> . .
  14094. l.r r.R
  14095. @end example
  14096. @item 2, 6, cclock
  14097. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  14098. @example
  14099. L.R R.r
  14100. . . -> . .
  14101. l.r L.l
  14102. @end example
  14103. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  14104. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  14105. @example
  14106. L.R r.R
  14107. . . -> . .
  14108. l.r l.L
  14109. @end example
  14110. @end table
  14111. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  14112. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  14113. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  14114. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  14115. symbolic constants.
  14116. @item passthrough
  14117. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14118. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14119. @table @samp
  14120. @item none
  14121. Always apply transposition.
  14122. @item portrait
  14123. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14124. @item landscape
  14125. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14126. @end table
  14127. Default value is @code{none}.
  14128. @end table
  14129. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  14130. layout:
  14131. @example
  14132. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  14133. @end example
  14134. The command above can also be specified as:
  14135. @example
  14136. transpose=1:portrait
  14137. @end example
  14138. @section transpose_npp
  14139. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14140. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  14141. It accepts the following parameters:
  14142. @table @option
  14143. @item dir
  14144. Specify the transposition direction.
  14145. Can assume the following values:
  14146. @table @samp
  14147. @item cclock_flip
  14148. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  14149. @item clock
  14150. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  14151. @item cclock
  14152. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  14153. @item clock_flip
  14154. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  14155. @end table
  14156. @item passthrough
  14157. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14158. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14159. @table @samp
  14160. @item none
  14161. Always apply transposition. (default)
  14162. @item portrait
  14163. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14164. @item landscape
  14165. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14166. @end table
  14167. @end table
  14168. @section trim
  14169. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  14170. It accepts the following parameters:
  14171. @table @option
  14172. @item start
  14173. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  14174. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  14175. @item end
  14176. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  14177. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  14178. frame in the output.
  14179. @item start_pts
  14180. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  14181. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14182. @item end_pts
  14183. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  14184. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14185. @item duration
  14186. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  14187. @item start_frame
  14188. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  14189. @item end_frame
  14190. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  14191. @end table
  14192. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  14193. duration specifications; see
  14194. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14195. for the accepted syntax.
  14196. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  14197. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  14198. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  14199. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  14200. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  14201. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  14202. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  14203. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  14204. filters.
  14205. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  14206. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  14207. Examples:
  14208. @itemize
  14209. @item
  14210. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  14211. @example
  14212. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  14213. @end example
  14214. @item
  14215. Keep only the first second:
  14216. @example
  14217. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  14218. @end example
  14219. @end itemize
  14220. @section unpremultiply
  14221. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  14222. of second stream as alpha.
  14223. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  14224. The filter accepts the following option:
  14225. @table @option
  14226. @item planes
  14227. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  14228. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  14229. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  14230. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  14231. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  14232. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  14233. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  14234. @item inplace
  14235. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  14236. @end table
  14237. @anchor{unsharp}
  14238. @section unsharp
  14239. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  14240. It accepts the following parameters:
  14241. @table @option
  14242. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  14243. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  14244. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14245. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  14246. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  14247. and 23. The default value is 5.
  14248. @item luma_amount, la
  14249. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14250. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14251. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14252. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14253. Default value is 1.0.
  14254. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  14255. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  14256. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14257. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  14258. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  14259. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14260. @item chroma_amount, ca
  14261. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14262. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14263. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14264. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14265. Default value is 0.0.
  14266. @end table
  14267. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  14268. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  14269. @subsection Examples
  14270. @itemize
  14271. @item
  14272. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  14273. @example
  14274. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  14275. @end example
  14276. @item
  14277. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  14278. @example
  14279. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  14280. @end example
  14281. @end itemize
  14282. @section uspp
  14283. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  14284. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  14285. shifts and average the results.
  14286. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  14287. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  14288. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  14289. The filter accepts the following options:
  14290. @table @option
  14291. @item quality
  14292. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  14293. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  14294. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  14295. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  14296. @code{3}.
  14297. @item qp
  14298. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  14299. from the video stream (if available).
  14300. @end table
  14301. @section v360
  14302. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  14303. The filter accepts the following options:
  14304. @table @option
  14305. @item input
  14306. @item output
  14307. Set format of the input/output video.
  14308. Available formats:
  14309. @table @samp
  14310. @item e
  14311. @item equirect
  14312. Equirectangular projection.
  14313. @item c3x2
  14314. @item c6x1
  14315. @item c1x6
  14316. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  14317. Format specific options:
  14318. @table @option
  14319. @item in_pad
  14320. @item out_pad
  14321. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  14322. Example values:
  14323. @table @samp
  14324. @item 0
  14325. No padding.
  14326. @item 0.01
  14327. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  14328. @end table
  14329. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14330. @item fin_pad
  14331. @item fout_pad
  14332. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  14333. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  14334. @item in_forder
  14335. @item out_forder
  14336. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  14337. Designation of directions:
  14338. @table @samp
  14339. @item r
  14340. right
  14341. @item l
  14342. left
  14343. @item u
  14344. up
  14345. @item d
  14346. down
  14347. @item f
  14348. forward
  14349. @item b
  14350. back
  14351. @end table
  14352. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  14353. @item in_frot
  14354. @item out_frot
  14355. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  14356. Designation of angles:
  14357. @table @samp
  14358. @item 0
  14359. 0 degrees clockwise
  14360. @item 1
  14361. 90 degrees clockwise
  14362. @item 2
  14363. 180 degrees clockwise
  14364. @item 3
  14365. 270 degrees clockwise
  14366. @end table
  14367. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  14368. @end table
  14369. @item eac
  14370. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  14371. @item flat
  14372. @item gnomonic
  14373. @item rectilinear
  14374. Regular video.
  14375. Format specific options:
  14376. @table @option
  14377. @item h_fov
  14378. @item v_fov
  14379. @item d_fov
  14380. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14381. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14382. @item ih_fov
  14383. @item iv_fov
  14384. @item id_fov
  14385. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14386. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14387. @end table
  14388. @item dfisheye
  14389. Dual fisheye.
  14390. Format specific options:
  14391. @table @option
  14392. @item in_pad
  14393. @item out_pad
  14394. Set padding proportion. Values in decimals.
  14395. Example values:
  14396. @table @samp
  14397. @item 0
  14398. No padding.
  14399. @item 0.01
  14400. 1% padding.
  14401. @end table
  14402. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14403. @end table
  14404. @item barrel
  14405. @item fb
  14406. Facebook's 360 format.
  14407. @item sg
  14408. Stereographic format.
  14409. Format specific options:
  14410. @table @option
  14411. @item h_fov
  14412. @item v_fov
  14413. @item d_fov
  14414. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14415. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14416. @item ih_fov
  14417. @item iv_fov
  14418. @item id_fov
  14419. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14420. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14421. @end table
  14422. @item mercator
  14423. Mercator format.
  14424. @item ball
  14425. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  14426. @item hammer
  14427. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  14428. @item sinusoidal
  14429. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  14430. @item fisheye
  14431. Fisheye projection.
  14432. Format specific options:
  14433. @table @option
  14434. @item h_fov
  14435. @item v_fov
  14436. @item d_fov
  14437. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14438. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14439. @item ih_fov
  14440. @item iv_fov
  14441. @item id_fov
  14442. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14443. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14444. @end table
  14445. @item pannini
  14446. Pannini projection. @i{(output only)}
  14447. Format specific options:
  14448. @table @option
  14449. @item h_fov
  14450. Set pannini parameter.
  14451. @end table
  14452. @item cylindrical
  14453. Cylindrical projection.
  14454. Format specific options:
  14455. @table @option
  14456. @item h_fov
  14457. @item v_fov
  14458. @item d_fov
  14459. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14460. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14461. @item ih_fov
  14462. @item iv_fov
  14463. @item id_fov
  14464. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14465. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14466. @end table
  14467. @item perspective
  14468. Perspective projection. @i{(output only)}
  14469. Format specific options:
  14470. @table @option
  14471. @item v_fov
  14472. Set perspective parameter.
  14473. @end table
  14474. @item tetrahedron
  14475. Tetrahedron projection.
  14476. @end table
  14477. @item interp
  14478. Set interpolation method.@*
  14479. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  14480. Available methods:
  14481. @table @samp
  14482. @item near
  14483. @item nearest
  14484. Nearest neighbour.
  14485. @item line
  14486. @item linear
  14487. Bilinear interpolation.
  14488. @item cube
  14489. @item cubic
  14490. Bicubic interpolation.
  14491. @item lanc
  14492. @item lanczos
  14493. Lanczos interpolation.
  14494. @item sp16
  14495. @item spline16
  14496. Spline16 interpolation.
  14497. @item gauss
  14498. @item gaussian
  14499. Gaussian interpolation.
  14500. @end table
  14501. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  14502. @item w
  14503. @item h
  14504. Set the output video resolution.
  14505. Default resolution depends on formats.
  14506. @item in_stereo
  14507. @item out_stereo
  14508. Set the input/output stereo format.
  14509. @table @samp
  14510. @item 2d
  14511. 2D mono
  14512. @item sbs
  14513. Side by side
  14514. @item tb
  14515. Top bottom
  14516. @end table
  14517. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14518. @item yaw
  14519. @item pitch
  14520. @item roll
  14521. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14522. @item rorder
  14523. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14524. @table @samp
  14525. @item y, Y
  14526. yaw
  14527. @item p, P
  14528. pitch
  14529. @item r, R
  14530. roll
  14531. @end table
  14532. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14533. @item h_flip
  14534. @item v_flip
  14535. @item d_flip
  14536. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14537. @item ih_flip
  14538. @item iv_flip
  14539. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14540. @item in_trans
  14541. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14542. @item out_trans
  14543. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14544. @item alpha_mask
  14545. Build mask in alpha plane for all unmapped pixels by marking them fully transparent. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14546. @end table
  14547. @subsection Examples
  14548. @itemize
  14549. @item
  14550. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14551. @example
  14552. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14553. @end example
  14554. @item
  14555. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14556. @example
  14557. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14558. @end example
  14559. @item
  14560. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14561. @example
  14562. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14563. @end example
  14564. @end itemize
  14565. @section vaguedenoiser
  14566. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14567. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14568. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14569. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14570. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14571. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14572. This filter accepts the following options:
  14573. @table @option
  14574. @item threshold
  14575. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14576. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14577. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14578. @item method
  14579. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14580. It accepts the following values:
  14581. @table @samp
  14582. @item hard
  14583. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14584. @item soft
  14585. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14586. reduced by the threshold.
  14587. @item garrote
  14588. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14589. (less) hard thresholding.
  14590. @end table
  14591. Default is garrote.
  14592. @item nsteps
  14593. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14594. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14595. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14596. @item percent
  14597. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14598. @item planes
  14599. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14600. @end table
  14601. @section vectorscope
  14602. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14603. a vectorscope).
  14604. This filter accepts the following options:
  14605. @table @option
  14606. @item mode, m
  14607. Set vectorscope mode.
  14608. It accepts the following values:
  14609. @table @samp
  14610. @item gray
  14611. @item tint
  14612. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14613. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14614. @item color
  14615. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14616. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14617. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14618. @item color2
  14619. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14620. @item color3
  14621. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14622. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14623. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14624. @item color4
  14625. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14626. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14627. not present in graph is picked.
  14628. @item color5
  14629. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14630. component picked from radial gradient.
  14631. @end table
  14632. @item x
  14633. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14634. @item y
  14635. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14636. @item intensity, i
  14637. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14638. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14639. @item envelope, e
  14640. @table @samp
  14641. @item none
  14642. No envelope, this is default.
  14643. @item instant
  14644. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14645. @item peak
  14646. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14647. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14648. @item peak+instant
  14649. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14650. @end table
  14651. @item graticule, g
  14652. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14653. @table @samp
  14654. @item none
  14655. @item green
  14656. @item color
  14657. @item invert
  14658. @end table
  14659. @item opacity, o
  14660. Set graticule opacity.
  14661. @item flags, f
  14662. Set graticule flags.
  14663. @table @samp
  14664. @item white
  14665. Draw graticule for white point.
  14666. @item black
  14667. Draw graticule for black point.
  14668. @item name
  14669. Draw color points short names.
  14670. @end table
  14671. @item bgopacity, b
  14672. Set background opacity.
  14673. @item lthreshold, l
  14674. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14675. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14676. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14677. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14678. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14679. @item hthreshold, h
  14680. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14681. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14682. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14683. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14684. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14685. @item colorspace, c
  14686. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14687. @table @samp
  14688. @item auto
  14689. @item 601
  14690. @item 709
  14691. @end table
  14692. Default is auto.
  14693. @item tint0, t0
  14694. @item tint1, t1
  14695. Set color tint for gray/tint vectorscope mode. By default both options are zero.
  14696. This means no tint, and output will remain gray.
  14697. @end table
  14698. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14699. @section vidstabdetect
  14700. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14701. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14702. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14703. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14704. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14705. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14706. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14707. This filter accepts the following options:
  14708. @table @option
  14709. @item result
  14710. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14711. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14712. @item shakiness
  14713. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14714. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14715. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14716. @item accuracy
  14717. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14718. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14719. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14720. @item stepsize
  14721. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14722. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14723. @item mincontrast
  14724. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14725. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14726. value is 0.3.
  14727. @item tripod
  14728. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  14729. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  14730. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  14731. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  14732. the camera view absolutely still.
  14733. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  14734. @item show
  14735. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  14736. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  14737. visualization.
  14738. @end table
  14739. @subsection Examples
  14740. @itemize
  14741. @item
  14742. Use default values:
  14743. @example
  14744. vidstabdetect
  14745. @end example
  14746. @item
  14747. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  14748. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  14749. @example
  14750. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  14751. @end example
  14752. @item
  14753. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  14754. video:
  14755. @example
  14756. vidstabdetect=show=1
  14757. @end example
  14758. @item
  14759. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  14760. @example
  14761. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  14762. @end example
  14763. @end itemize
  14764. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  14765. @section vidstabtransform
  14766. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  14767. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  14768. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  14769. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  14770. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  14771. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  14772. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  14773. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14774. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14775. @subsection Options
  14776. @table @option
  14777. @item input
  14778. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  14779. @file{transforms.trf}.
  14780. @item smoothing
  14781. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  14782. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  14783. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  14784. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  14785. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  14786. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  14787. camera is simulated.
  14788. @item optalgo
  14789. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  14790. Accepted values are:
  14791. @table @samp
  14792. @item gauss
  14793. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  14794. @item avg
  14795. averaging on transformations
  14796. @end table
  14797. @item maxshift
  14798. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  14799. meaning no limit.
  14800. @item maxangle
  14801. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  14802. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  14803. @item crop
  14804. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  14805. compensation.
  14806. Available values are:
  14807. @table @samp
  14808. @item keep
  14809. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  14810. @item black
  14811. fill the border black
  14812. @end table
  14813. @item invert
  14814. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  14815. @item relative
  14816. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  14817. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  14818. @item zoom
  14819. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  14820. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  14821. zoom).
  14822. @item optzoom
  14823. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  14824. Accepted values are:
  14825. @table @samp
  14826. @item 0
  14827. disabled
  14828. @item 1
  14829. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  14830. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  14831. @item 2
  14832. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  14833. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  14834. @end table
  14835. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  14836. @item zoomspeed
  14837. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  14838. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  14839. 0.25.
  14840. @item interpol
  14841. Specify type of interpolation.
  14842. Available values are:
  14843. @table @samp
  14844. @item no
  14845. no interpolation
  14846. @item linear
  14847. linear only horizontal
  14848. @item bilinear
  14849. linear in both directions (default)
  14850. @item bicubic
  14851. cubic in both directions (slow)
  14852. @end table
  14853. @item tripod
  14854. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  14855. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  14856. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  14857. @item debug
  14858. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  14859. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  14860. value is 0.
  14861. @end table
  14862. @subsection Examples
  14863. @itemize
  14864. @item
  14865. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  14866. @example
  14867. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  14868. @end example
  14869. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  14870. @item
  14871. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  14872. @example
  14873. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  14874. @end example
  14875. @item
  14876. Smoothen the video even more:
  14877. @example
  14878. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  14879. @end example
  14880. @end itemize
  14881. @section vflip
  14882. Flip the input video vertically.
  14883. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  14884. @example
  14885. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  14886. @end example
  14887. @section vfrdet
  14888. Detect variable frame rate video.
  14889. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  14890. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  14891. and ones with constant delta pts.
  14892. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and
  14893. average delta encountered.
  14894. @section vibrance
  14895. Boost or alter saturation.
  14896. The filter accepts the following options:
  14897. @table @option
  14898. @item intensity
  14899. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  14900. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  14901. @item rbal
  14902. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14903. @item gbal
  14904. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14905. @item bbal
  14906. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14907. @item rlum
  14908. Set the red luma coefficient.
  14909. @item glum
  14910. Set the green luma coefficient.
  14911. @item blum
  14912. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  14913. @item alternate
  14914. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  14915. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  14916. @end table
  14917. @subsection Commands
  14918. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  14919. @anchor{vignette}
  14920. @section vignette
  14921. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  14922. The filter accepts the following options:
  14923. @table @option
  14924. @item angle, a
  14925. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  14926. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  14927. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  14928. @item x0
  14929. @item y0
  14930. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  14931. by default.
  14932. @item mode
  14933. Set forward/backward mode.
  14934. Available modes are:
  14935. @table @samp
  14936. @item forward
  14937. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  14938. @item backward
  14939. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  14940. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  14941. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  14942. also be used to create a burning effect.
  14943. @end table
  14944. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  14945. @item eval
  14946. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  14947. It accepts the following values:
  14948. @table @samp
  14949. @item init
  14950. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  14951. @item frame
  14952. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  14953. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  14954. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  14955. @end table
  14956. Default value is @samp{init}.
  14957. @item dither
  14958. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  14959. (enabled).
  14960. @item aspect
  14961. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  14962. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  14963. following the dimensions of the video.
  14964. Default is @code{1/1}.
  14965. @end table
  14966. @subsection Expressions
  14967. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  14968. following parameters.
  14969. @table @option
  14970. @item w
  14971. @item h
  14972. input width and height
  14973. @item n
  14974. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  14975. @item pts
  14976. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  14977. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  14978. @item r
  14979. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  14980. @item t
  14981. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  14982. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  14983. @item tb
  14984. time base of the input video
  14985. @end table
  14986. @subsection Examples
  14987. @itemize
  14988. @item
  14989. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  14990. @example
  14991. vignette=PI/4
  14992. @end example
  14993. @item
  14994. Make a flickering vignetting:
  14995. @example
  14996. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  14997. @end example
  14998. @end itemize
  14999. @section vmafmotion
  15000. Obtain the average VMAF motion score of a video.
  15001. It is one of the component metrics of VMAF.
  15002. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  15003. The filter accepts the following options:
  15004. @table @option
  15005. @item stats_file
  15006. If specified, the filter will use the named file to save the motion score of
  15007. each frame with respect to the previous frame.
  15008. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.
  15009. @end table
  15010. Example:
  15011. @example
  15012. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -vf vmafmotion -f null -
  15013. @end example
  15014. @section vstack
  15015. Stack input videos vertically.
  15016. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  15017. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  15018. to create same output.
  15019. The filter accepts the following options:
  15020. @table @option
  15021. @item inputs
  15022. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15023. @item shortest
  15024. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15025. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15026. @end table
  15027. @section w3fdif
  15028. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  15029. Deinterlacing Filter").
  15030. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  15031. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  15032. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  15033. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  15034. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  15035. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  15036. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  15037. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  15038. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  15039. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  15040. @table @option
  15041. @item filter
  15042. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  15043. @table @samp
  15044. @item simple
  15045. Simple filter coefficient set.
  15046. @item complex
  15047. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  15048. @end table
  15049. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  15050. @item deint
  15051. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  15052. @table @samp
  15053. @item all
  15054. Deinterlace all frames,
  15055. @item interlaced
  15056. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15057. @end table
  15058. Default value is @samp{all}.
  15059. @end table
  15060. @section waveform
  15061. Video waveform monitor.
  15062. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  15063. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  15064. source video.
  15065. It accepts the following options:
  15066. @table @option
  15067. @item mode, m
  15068. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  15069. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  15070. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  15071. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  15072. @item intensity, i
  15073. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  15074. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  15075. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  15076. @item mirror, r
  15077. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  15078. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  15079. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  15080. @code{1} (mirrored).
  15081. @item display, d
  15082. Set display mode.
  15083. It accepts the following values:
  15084. @table @samp
  15085. @item overlay
  15086. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  15087. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  15088. over one another.
  15089. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  15090. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  15091. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  15092. @item stack
  15093. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15094. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  15095. @item parade
  15096. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15097. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  15098. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  15099. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  15100. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  15101. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  15102. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  15103. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  15104. @end table
  15105. Default is @code{stack}.
  15106. @item components, c
  15107. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  15108. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  15109. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  15110. @item envelope, e
  15111. @table @samp
  15112. @item none
  15113. No envelope, this is default.
  15114. @item instant
  15115. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  15116. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  15117. @item peak
  15118. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  15119. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  15120. @item peak+instant
  15121. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  15122. @end table
  15123. @item filter, f
  15124. @table @samp
  15125. @item lowpass
  15126. No filtering, this is default.
  15127. @item flat
  15128. Luma and chroma combined together.
  15129. @item aflat
  15130. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  15131. @item xflat
  15132. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  15133. @item yflat
  15134. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  15135. @item chroma
  15136. Displays only chroma.
  15137. @item color
  15138. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  15139. @item acolor
  15140. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  15141. @end table
  15142. @item graticule, g
  15143. Set which graticule to display.
  15144. @table @samp
  15145. @item none
  15146. Do not display graticule.
  15147. @item green
  15148. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15149. @item orange
  15150. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15151. @item invert
  15152. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15153. @end table
  15154. @item opacity, o
  15155. Set graticule opacity.
  15156. @item flags, fl
  15157. Set graticule flags.
  15158. @table @samp
  15159. @item numbers
  15160. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  15161. @item dots
  15162. Draw dots instead of lines.
  15163. @end table
  15164. @item scale, s
  15165. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  15166. @table @samp
  15167. @item digital
  15168. @item millivolts
  15169. @item ire
  15170. @end table
  15171. Default is digital.
  15172. @item bgopacity, b
  15173. Set background opacity.
  15174. @item tint0, t0
  15175. @item tint1, t1
  15176. Set tint for output.
  15177. Only used with lowpass filter and when display is not overlay and input
  15178. pixel formats are not RGB.
  15179. @end table
  15180. @section weave, doubleweave
  15181. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  15182. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  15183. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  15184. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  15185. halving frame rate and frame count.
  15186. It accepts the following option:
  15187. @table @option
  15188. @item first_field
  15189. Set first field. Available values are:
  15190. @table @samp
  15191. @item top, t
  15192. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  15193. @item bottom, b
  15194. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  15195. @end table
  15196. @end table
  15197. @subsection Examples
  15198. @itemize
  15199. @item
  15200. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  15201. @example
  15202. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  15203. @end example
  15204. @end itemize
  15205. @section xbr
  15206. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  15207. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  15208. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  15209. It accepts the following option:
  15210. @table @option
  15211. @item n
  15212. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  15213. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  15214. Default is @code{3}.
  15215. @end table
  15216. @section xfade
  15217. Apply cross fade from one input video stream to another input video stream.
  15218. The cross fade is applied for specified duration.
  15219. The filter accepts the following options:
  15220. @table @option
  15221. @item transition
  15222. Set one of available transition effects:
  15223. @table @samp
  15224. @item custom
  15225. @item fade
  15226. @item wipeleft
  15227. @item wiperight
  15228. @item wipeup
  15229. @item wipedown
  15230. @item slideleft
  15231. @item slideright
  15232. @item slideup
  15233. @item slidedown
  15234. @item circlecrop
  15235. @item rectcrop
  15236. @item distance
  15237. @item fadeblack
  15238. @item fadewhite
  15239. @item radial
  15240. @item smoothleft
  15241. @item smoothright
  15242. @item smoothup
  15243. @item smoothdown
  15244. @item circleopen
  15245. @item circleclose
  15246. @item vertopen
  15247. @item vertclose
  15248. @item horzopen
  15249. @item horzclose
  15250. @item dissolve
  15251. @item pixelize
  15252. @item diagtl
  15253. @item diagtr
  15254. @item diagbl
  15255. @item diagbr
  15256. @end table
  15257. Default transition effect is fade.
  15258. @item duration
  15259. Set cross fade duration in seconds.
  15260. Default duration is 1 second.
  15261. @item offset
  15262. Set cross fade start relative to first input stream in seconds.
  15263. Default offset is 0.
  15264. @item expr
  15265. Set expression for custom transition effect.
  15266. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  15267. @table @option
  15268. @item X
  15269. @item Y
  15270. The coordinates of the current sample.
  15271. @item W
  15272. @item H
  15273. The width and height of the image.
  15274. @item P
  15275. Progress of transition effect.
  15276. @item PLANE
  15277. Currently processed plane.
  15278. @item A
  15279. Return value of first input at current location and plane.
  15280. @item B
  15281. Return value of second input at current location and plane.
  15282. @item a0(x, y)
  15283. @item a1(x, y)
  15284. @item a2(x, y)
  15285. @item a3(x, y)
  15286. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15287. first/second/third/fourth component of first input.
  15288. @item b0(x, y)
  15289. @item b1(x, y)
  15290. @item b2(x, y)
  15291. @item b3(x, y)
  15292. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15293. first/second/third/fourth component of second input.
  15294. @end table
  15295. @end table
  15296. @subsection Examples
  15297. @itemize
  15298. @item
  15299. Cross fade from one input video to another input video, with fade transition and duration of transition
  15300. of 2 seconds starting at offset of 5 seconds:
  15301. @example
  15302. ffmpeg -i first.mp4 -i second.mp4 -filter_complex xfade=transition=fade:duration=2:offset=5 output.mp4
  15303. @end example
  15304. @end itemize
  15305. @section xmedian
  15306. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  15307. The filter accepts the following options:
  15308. @table @option
  15309. @item inputs
  15310. Set number of inputs.
  15311. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  15312. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  15313. @item planes
  15314. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  15315. @item percentile
  15316. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  15317. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  15318. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  15319. @end table
  15320. @section xstack
  15321. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  15322. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  15323. The filter accepts the following options:
  15324. @table @option
  15325. @item inputs
  15326. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15327. @item layout
  15328. Specify layout of inputs.
  15329. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  15330. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  15331. is separated by '|'.
  15332. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  15333. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  15334. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  15335. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  15336. case values are summed together.
  15337. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  15338. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  15339. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  15340. adjoining videos.
  15341. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  15342. a layout must be set by the user.
  15343. @item shortest
  15344. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15345. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15346. @item fill
  15347. If set to valid color, all unused pixels will be filled with that color.
  15348. By default fill is set to none, so it is disabled.
  15349. @end table
  15350. @subsection Examples
  15351. @itemize
  15352. @item
  15353. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  15354. Layout:
  15355. @example
  15356. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  15357. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  15358. @end example
  15359. @example
  15360. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  15361. @end example
  15362. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15363. @item
  15364. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  15365. Layout:
  15366. @example
  15367. input1(0, 0)
  15368. input2(0, h0)
  15369. input3(0, h0+h1)
  15370. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  15371. @end example
  15372. @example
  15373. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  15374. @end example
  15375. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  15376. @item
  15377. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  15378. Layout:
  15379. @example
  15380. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  15381. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  15382. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  15383. @end example
  15384. @example
  15385. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  15386. @end example
  15387. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15388. @item
  15389. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  15390. Layout:
  15391. @example
  15392. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  15393. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  15394. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  15395. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  15396. @end example
  15397. @example
  15398. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  15399. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  15400. @end example
  15401. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15402. @end itemize
  15403. @anchor{yadif}
  15404. @section yadif
  15405. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  15406. filter").
  15407. It accepts the following parameters:
  15408. @table @option
  15409. @item mode
  15410. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15411. @table @option
  15412. @item 0, send_frame
  15413. Output one frame for each frame.
  15414. @item 1, send_field
  15415. Output one frame for each field.
  15416. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15417. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15418. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15419. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15420. @end table
  15421. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15422. @item parity
  15423. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15424. of the following values:
  15425. @table @option
  15426. @item 0, tff
  15427. Assume the top field is first.
  15428. @item 1, bff
  15429. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15430. @item -1, auto
  15431. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15432. @end table
  15433. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15434. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15435. top field first will be assumed.
  15436. @item deint
  15437. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15438. values:
  15439. @table @option
  15440. @item 0, all
  15441. Deinterlace all frames.
  15442. @item 1, interlaced
  15443. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15444. @end table
  15445. The default value is @code{all}.
  15446. @end table
  15447. @section yadif_cuda
  15448. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  15449. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  15450. and/or nvenc.
  15451. It accepts the following parameters:
  15452. @table @option
  15453. @item mode
  15454. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15455. @table @option
  15456. @item 0, send_frame
  15457. Output one frame for each frame.
  15458. @item 1, send_field
  15459. Output one frame for each field.
  15460. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15461. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15462. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15463. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15464. @end table
  15465. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15466. @item parity
  15467. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15468. of the following values:
  15469. @table @option
  15470. @item 0, tff
  15471. Assume the top field is first.
  15472. @item 1, bff
  15473. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15474. @item -1, auto
  15475. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15476. @end table
  15477. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15478. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15479. top field first will be assumed.
  15480. @item deint
  15481. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15482. values:
  15483. @table @option
  15484. @item 0, all
  15485. Deinterlace all frames.
  15486. @item 1, interlaced
  15487. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15488. @end table
  15489. The default value is @code{all}.
  15490. @end table
  15491. @section yaepblur
  15492. Apply blur filter while preserving edges ("yaepblur" means "yet another edge preserving blur filter").
  15493. The algorithm is described in
  15494. "J. S. Lee, Digital image enhancement and noise filtering by use of local statistics, IEEE Trans. Pattern Anal. Mach. Intell. PAMI-2, 1980."
  15495. It accepts the following parameters:
  15496. @table @option
  15497. @item radius, r
  15498. Set the window radius. Default value is 3.
  15499. @item planes, p
  15500. Set which planes to filter. Default is only the first plane.
  15501. @item sigma, s
  15502. Set blur strength. Default value is 128.
  15503. @end table
  15504. @subsection Commands
  15505. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  15506. @section zoompan
  15507. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  15508. This filter accepts the following options:
  15509. @table @option
  15510. @item zoom, z
  15511. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  15512. @item x
  15513. @item y
  15514. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  15515. @item d
  15516. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  15517. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  15518. single input image.
  15519. @item s
  15520. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  15521. @item fps
  15522. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  15523. @end table
  15524. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  15525. @table @option
  15526. @item in_w, iw
  15527. Input width.
  15528. @item in_h, ih
  15529. Input height.
  15530. @item out_w, ow
  15531. Output width.
  15532. @item out_h, oh
  15533. Output height.
  15534. @item in
  15535. Input frame count.
  15536. @item on
  15537. Output frame count.
  15538. @item x
  15539. @item y
  15540. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  15541. for current input frame.
  15542. @item px
  15543. @item py
  15544. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  15545. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  15546. @item zoom
  15547. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  15548. @item pzoom
  15549. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  15550. @item duration
  15551. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  15552. for each input frame.
  15553. @item pduration
  15554. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  15555. @item a
  15556. Rational number: input width / input height
  15557. @item sar
  15558. sample aspect ratio
  15559. @item dar
  15560. display aspect ratio
  15561. @end table
  15562. @subsection Examples
  15563. @itemize
  15564. @item
  15565. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  15566. @example
  15567. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  15568. @end example
  15569. @item
  15570. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  15571. @example
  15572. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15573. @end example
  15574. @item
  15575. Same as above but without pausing:
  15576. @example
  15577. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15578. @end example
  15579. @end itemize
  15580. @anchor{zscale}
  15581. @section zscale
  15582. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  15583. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  15584. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  15585. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  15586. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  15587. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  15588. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  15589. requested format.
  15590. @subsection Options
  15591. The filter accepts the following options.
  15592. @table @option
  15593. @item width, w
  15594. @item height, h
  15595. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  15596. dimension.
  15597. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  15598. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  15599. is used for the output.
  15600. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  15601. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  15602. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  15603. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  15604. adjust the value if necessary.
  15605. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  15606. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  15607. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  15608. expression.
  15609. @item size, s
  15610. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15611. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15612. @item dither, d
  15613. Set the dither type.
  15614. Possible values are:
  15615. @table @var
  15616. @item none
  15617. @item ordered
  15618. @item random
  15619. @item error_diffusion
  15620. @end table
  15621. Default is none.
  15622. @item filter, f
  15623. Set the resize filter type.
  15624. Possible values are:
  15625. @table @var
  15626. @item point
  15627. @item bilinear
  15628. @item bicubic
  15629. @item spline16
  15630. @item spline36
  15631. @item lanczos
  15632. @end table
  15633. Default is bilinear.
  15634. @item range, r
  15635. Set the color range.
  15636. Possible values are:
  15637. @table @var
  15638. @item input
  15639. @item limited
  15640. @item full
  15641. @end table
  15642. Default is same as input.
  15643. @item primaries, p
  15644. Set the color primaries.
  15645. Possible values are:
  15646. @table @var
  15647. @item input
  15648. @item 709
  15649. @item unspecified
  15650. @item 170m
  15651. @item 240m
  15652. @item 2020
  15653. @end table
  15654. Default is same as input.
  15655. @item transfer, t
  15656. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15657. Possible values are:
  15658. @table @var
  15659. @item input
  15660. @item 709
  15661. @item unspecified
  15662. @item 601
  15663. @item linear
  15664. @item 2020_10
  15665. @item 2020_12
  15666. @item smpte2084
  15667. @item iec61966-2-1
  15668. @item arib-std-b67
  15669. @end table
  15670. Default is same as input.
  15671. @item matrix, m
  15672. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15673. Possible value are:
  15674. @table @var
  15675. @item input
  15676. @item 709
  15677. @item unspecified
  15678. @item 470bg
  15679. @item 170m
  15680. @item 2020_ncl
  15681. @item 2020_cl
  15682. @end table
  15683. Default is same as input.
  15684. @item rangein, rin
  15685. Set the input color range.
  15686. Possible values are:
  15687. @table @var
  15688. @item input
  15689. @item limited
  15690. @item full
  15691. @end table
  15692. Default is same as input.
  15693. @item primariesin, pin
  15694. Set the input color primaries.
  15695. Possible values are:
  15696. @table @var
  15697. @item input
  15698. @item 709
  15699. @item unspecified
  15700. @item 170m
  15701. @item 240m
  15702. @item 2020
  15703. @end table
  15704. Default is same as input.
  15705. @item transferin, tin
  15706. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15707. Possible values are:
  15708. @table @var
  15709. @item input
  15710. @item 709
  15711. @item unspecified
  15712. @item 601
  15713. @item linear
  15714. @item 2020_10
  15715. @item 2020_12
  15716. @end table
  15717. Default is same as input.
  15718. @item matrixin, min
  15719. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  15720. Possible value are:
  15721. @table @var
  15722. @item input
  15723. @item 709
  15724. @item unspecified
  15725. @item 470bg
  15726. @item 170m
  15727. @item 2020_ncl
  15728. @item 2020_cl
  15729. @end table
  15730. @item chromal, c
  15731. Set the output chroma location.
  15732. Possible values are:
  15733. @table @var
  15734. @item input
  15735. @item left
  15736. @item center
  15737. @item topleft
  15738. @item top
  15739. @item bottomleft
  15740. @item bottom
  15741. @end table
  15742. @item chromalin, cin
  15743. Set the input chroma location.
  15744. Possible values are:
  15745. @table @var
  15746. @item input
  15747. @item left
  15748. @item center
  15749. @item topleft
  15750. @item top
  15751. @item bottomleft
  15752. @item bottom
  15753. @end table
  15754. @item npl
  15755. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  15756. @end table
  15757. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  15758. containing the following constants:
  15759. @table @var
  15760. @item in_w
  15761. @item in_h
  15762. The input width and height
  15763. @item iw
  15764. @item ih
  15765. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  15766. @item out_w
  15767. @item out_h
  15768. The output (scaled) width and height
  15769. @item ow
  15770. @item oh
  15771. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  15772. @item a
  15773. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  15774. @item sar
  15775. input sample aspect ratio
  15776. @item dar
  15777. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  15778. @item hsub
  15779. @item vsub
  15780. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15781. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15782. @item ohsub
  15783. @item ovsub
  15784. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15785. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15786. @end table
  15787. @subsection Commands
  15788. This filter supports the following commands:
  15789. @table @option
  15790. @item width, w
  15791. @item height, h
  15792. Set the output video dimension expression.
  15793. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  15794. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  15795. value.
  15796. @end table
  15797. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  15798. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  15799. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15800. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  15801. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15802. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  15803. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  15804. @table @option
  15805. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  15806. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  15807. given device parameters.
  15808. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  15809. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  15810. @end table
  15811. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  15812. @itemize
  15813. @item
  15814. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  15815. @example
  15816. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15817. @end example
  15818. @end itemize
  15819. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  15820. @section avgblur_opencl
  15821. Apply average blur filter.
  15822. The filter accepts the following options:
  15823. @table @option
  15824. @item sizeX
  15825. Set horizontal radius size.
  15826. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  15827. @item planes
  15828. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15829. @item sizeY
  15830. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  15831. @end table
  15832. @subsection Example
  15833. @itemize
  15834. @item
  15835. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15836. @example
  15837. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15838. @end example
  15839. @end itemize
  15840. @section boxblur_opencl
  15841. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  15842. It accepts the following parameters:
  15843. @table @option
  15844. @item luma_radius, lr
  15845. @item luma_power, lp
  15846. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15847. @item chroma_power, cp
  15848. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15849. @item alpha_power, ap
  15850. @end table
  15851. A description of the accepted options follows.
  15852. @table @option
  15853. @item luma_radius, lr
  15854. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15855. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15856. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  15857. corresponding input plane.
  15858. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  15859. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  15860. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  15861. planes.
  15862. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  15863. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  15864. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  15865. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  15866. @table @option
  15867. @item w
  15868. @item h
  15869. The input width and height in pixels.
  15870. @item cw
  15871. @item ch
  15872. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  15873. @item hsub
  15874. @item vsub
  15875. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  15876. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15877. @end table
  15878. @item luma_power, lp
  15879. @item chroma_power, cp
  15880. @item alpha_power, ap
  15881. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  15882. corresponding plane.
  15883. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  15884. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  15885. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  15886. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  15887. @end table
  15888. @subsection Examples
  15889. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15890. @itemize
  15891. @item
  15892. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  15893. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  15894. @example
  15895. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15896. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15897. @end example
  15898. @item
  15899. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  15900. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  15901. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  15902. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  15903. @example
  15904. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15905. @end example
  15906. @end itemize
  15907. @section colorkey_opencl
  15908. RGB colorspace color keying.
  15909. The filter accepts the following options:
  15910. @table @option
  15911. @item color
  15912. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  15913. @item similarity
  15914. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  15915. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  15916. @item blend
  15917. Blend percentage.
  15918. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  15919. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  15920. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  15921. @end table
  15922. @subsection Examples
  15923. @itemize
  15924. @item
  15925. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  15926. @example
  15927. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15928. @end example
  15929. @end itemize
  15930. @section convolution_opencl
  15931. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  15932. The filter accepts the following options:
  15933. @table @option
  15934. @item 0m
  15935. @item 1m
  15936. @item 2m
  15937. @item 3m
  15938. Set matrix for each plane.
  15939. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  15940. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  15941. @item 0rdiv
  15942. @item 1rdiv
  15943. @item 2rdiv
  15944. @item 3rdiv
  15945. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  15946. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  15947. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  15948. @item 0bias
  15949. @item 1bias
  15950. @item 2bias
  15951. @item 3bias
  15952. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  15953. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  15954. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  15955. @end table
  15956. @subsection Examples
  15957. @itemize
  15958. @item
  15959. Apply sharpen:
  15960. @example
  15961. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15962. @end example
  15963. @item
  15964. Apply blur:
  15965. @example
  15966. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15967. @end example
  15968. @item
  15969. Apply edge enhance:
  15970. @example
  15971. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15972. @end example
  15973. @item
  15974. Apply edge detect:
  15975. @example
  15976. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15977. @end example
  15978. @item
  15979. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  15980. @example
  15981. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15982. @end example
  15983. @item
  15984. Apply emboss:
  15985. @example
  15986. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15987. @end example
  15988. @end itemize
  15989. @section erosion_opencl
  15990. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  15991. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  15992. It accepts the following options:
  15993. @table @option
  15994. @item threshold0
  15995. @item threshold1
  15996. @item threshold2
  15997. @item threshold3
  15998. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15999. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16000. @item coordinates
  16001. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16002. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16003. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16004. 1 2 3
  16005. 4 x 5
  16006. 6 7 8
  16007. @end table
  16008. @subsection Example
  16009. @itemize
  16010. @item
  16011. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  16012. @example
  16013. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16014. @end example
  16015. @end itemize
  16016. @section deshake_opencl
  16017. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  16018. The filter accepts the following options:
  16019. @table @option
  16020. @item tripod
  16021. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16022. @item debug
  16023. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  16024. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  16025. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  16026. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16027. @item adaptive_crop
  16028. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  16029. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16030. @item refine_features
  16031. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  16032. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  16033. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16034. @item smooth_strength
  16035. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  16036. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  16037. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  16038. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  16039. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  16040. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  16041. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  16042. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  16043. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  16044. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  16045. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  16046. @end table
  16047. @subsection Examples
  16048. @itemize
  16049. @item
  16050. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  16051. @example
  16052. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16053. @end example
  16054. @item
  16055. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  16056. @example
  16057. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  16058. @end example
  16059. @end itemize
  16060. @section dilation_opencl
  16061. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  16062. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  16063. It accepts the following options:
  16064. @table @option
  16065. @item threshold0
  16066. @item threshold1
  16067. @item threshold2
  16068. @item threshold3
  16069. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16070. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16071. @item coordinates
  16072. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16073. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16074. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16075. 1 2 3
  16076. 4 x 5
  16077. 6 7 8
  16078. @end table
  16079. @subsection Example
  16080. @itemize
  16081. @item
  16082. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  16083. @example
  16084. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16085. @end example
  16086. @end itemize
  16087. @section nlmeans_opencl
  16088. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  16089. @section overlay_opencl
  16090. Overlay one video on top of another.
  16091. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  16092. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  16093. The filter accepts the following options:
  16094. @table @option
  16095. @item x
  16096. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16097. Default value is @code{0}.
  16098. @item y
  16099. Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16100. Default value is @code{0}.
  16101. @end table
  16102. @subsection Examples
  16103. @itemize
  16104. @item
  16105. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  16106. @example
  16107. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16108. @end example
  16109. @item
  16110. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  16111. @example
  16112. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16113. @end example
  16114. @end itemize
  16115. @section pad_opencl
  16116. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  16117. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  16118. It accepts the following options:
  16119. @table @option
  16120. @item width, w
  16121. @item height, h
  16122. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  16123. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  16124. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  16125. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  16126. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  16127. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  16128. @item x
  16129. @item y
  16130. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  16131. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  16132. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  16133. expression, and vice versa.
  16134. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  16135. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  16136. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  16137. @item color
  16138. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  16139. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  16140. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16141. @item aspect
  16142. Pad to an aspect instead to a resolution.
  16143. @end table
  16144. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  16145. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  16146. @table @option
  16147. @item in_w
  16148. @item in_h
  16149. The input video width and height.
  16150. @item iw
  16151. @item ih
  16152. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  16153. @item out_w
  16154. @item out_h
  16155. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  16156. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  16157. @item ow
  16158. @item oh
  16159. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  16160. @item x
  16161. @item y
  16162. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  16163. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  16164. @item a
  16165. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  16166. @item sar
  16167. input sample aspect ratio
  16168. @item dar
  16169. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  16170. @end table
  16171. @section prewitt_opencl
  16172. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  16173. The filter accepts the following option:
  16174. @table @option
  16175. @item planes
  16176. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16177. @item scale
  16178. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16179. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16180. @item delta
  16181. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16182. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16183. @end table
  16184. @subsection Example
  16185. @itemize
  16186. @item
  16187. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  16188. @example
  16189. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16190. @end example
  16191. @end itemize
  16192. @anchor{program_opencl}
  16193. @section program_opencl
  16194. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  16195. @table @option
  16196. @item source
  16197. OpenCL program source file.
  16198. @item kernel
  16199. Kernel name in program.
  16200. @item inputs
  16201. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  16202. @item size, s
  16203. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  16204. @end table
  16205. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16206. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16207. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16208. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16209. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16210. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16211. @itemize
  16212. @item
  16213. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16214. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16215. @item
  16216. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  16217. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  16218. @item
  16219. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16220. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16221. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16222. @end itemize
  16223. Example programs:
  16224. @itemize
  16225. @item
  16226. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  16227. @verbatim
  16228. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  16229. unsigned int index,
  16230. __read_only image2d_t source)
  16231. {
  16232. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  16233. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16234. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  16235. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  16236. }
  16237. @end verbatim
  16238. @item
  16239. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  16240. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  16241. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  16242. @verbatim
  16243. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16244. unsigned int index,
  16245. __read_only image2d_t src)
  16246. {
  16247. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16248. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16249. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  16250. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16251. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  16252. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  16253. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  16254. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16255. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  16256. float2 src_pos = {
  16257. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  16258. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  16259. };
  16260. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  16261. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  16262. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  16263. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  16264. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  16265. else
  16266. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  16267. }
  16268. @end verbatim
  16269. @item
  16270. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  16271. with the index counter.
  16272. @verbatim
  16273. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16274. unsigned int index,
  16275. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16276. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  16277. {
  16278. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16279. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16280. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  16281. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16282. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16283. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16284. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  16285. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  16286. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  16287. }
  16288. @end verbatim
  16289. @end itemize
  16290. @section roberts_opencl
  16291. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  16292. The filter accepts the following option:
  16293. @table @option
  16294. @item planes
  16295. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16296. @item scale
  16297. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16298. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16299. @item delta
  16300. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16301. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16302. @end table
  16303. @subsection Example
  16304. @itemize
  16305. @item
  16306. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16307. @example
  16308. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16309. @end example
  16310. @end itemize
  16311. @section sobel_opencl
  16312. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  16313. The filter accepts the following option:
  16314. @table @option
  16315. @item planes
  16316. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16317. @item scale
  16318. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16319. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16320. @item delta
  16321. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16322. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16323. @end table
  16324. @subsection Example
  16325. @itemize
  16326. @item
  16327. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16328. @example
  16329. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16330. @end example
  16331. @end itemize
  16332. @section tonemap_opencl
  16333. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  16334. It accepts the following parameters:
  16335. @table @option
  16336. @item tonemap
  16337. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16338. @item param
  16339. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16340. @item desat
  16341. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  16342. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  16343. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  16344. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  16345. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  16346. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  16347. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  16348. @item threshold
  16349. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  16350. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  16351. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  16352. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  16353. The default value is 0.2.
  16354. @item format
  16355. Specify the output pixel format.
  16356. Currently supported formats are:
  16357. @table @var
  16358. @item p010
  16359. @item nv12
  16360. @end table
  16361. @item range, r
  16362. Set the output color range.
  16363. Possible values are:
  16364. @table @var
  16365. @item tv/mpeg
  16366. @item pc/jpeg
  16367. @end table
  16368. Default is same as input.
  16369. @item primaries, p
  16370. Set the output color primaries.
  16371. Possible values are:
  16372. @table @var
  16373. @item bt709
  16374. @item bt2020
  16375. @end table
  16376. Default is same as input.
  16377. @item transfer, t
  16378. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16379. Possible values are:
  16380. @table @var
  16381. @item bt709
  16382. @item bt2020
  16383. @end table
  16384. Default is bt709.
  16385. @item matrix, m
  16386. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16387. Possible value are:
  16388. @table @var
  16389. @item bt709
  16390. @item bt2020
  16391. @end table
  16392. Default is same as input.
  16393. @end table
  16394. @subsection Example
  16395. @itemize
  16396. @item
  16397. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  16398. @example
  16399. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  16400. @end example
  16401. @end itemize
  16402. @section unsharp_opencl
  16403. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  16404. It accepts the following parameters:
  16405. @table @option
  16406. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  16407. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  16408. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16409. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  16410. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  16411. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16412. @item luma_amount, la
  16413. Set the luma effect strength.
  16414. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16415. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16416. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16417. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  16418. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  16419. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16420. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  16421. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  16422. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16423. @item chroma_amount, ca
  16424. Set the chroma effect strength.
  16425. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16426. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16427. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16428. @end table
  16429. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  16430. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  16431. @subsection Examples
  16432. @itemize
  16433. @item
  16434. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  16435. @example
  16436. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16437. @end example
  16438. @item
  16439. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  16440. @example
  16441. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16442. @end example
  16443. @end itemize
  16444. @section xfade_opencl
  16445. Cross fade two videos with custom transition effect by using OpenCL.
  16446. It accepts the following options:
  16447. @table @option
  16448. @item transition
  16449. Set one of possible transition effects.
  16450. @table @option
  16451. @item custom
  16452. Select custom transition effect, the actual transition description
  16453. will be picked from source and kernel options.
  16454. @item fade
  16455. @item wipeleft
  16456. @item wiperight
  16457. @item wipeup
  16458. @item wipedown
  16459. @item slideleft
  16460. @item slideright
  16461. @item slideup
  16462. @item slidedown
  16463. Default transition is fade.
  16464. @end table
  16465. @item source
  16466. OpenCL program source file for custom transition.
  16467. @item kernel
  16468. Set name of kernel to use for custom transition from program source file.
  16469. @item duration
  16470. Set duration of video transition.
  16471. @item offset
  16472. Set time of start of transition relative to first video.
  16473. @end table
  16474. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16475. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16476. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16477. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16478. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16479. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16480. @itemize
  16481. @item
  16482. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16483. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16484. @item
  16485. First Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16486. Second Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16487. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16488. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16489. @item
  16490. Transition progress, @var{float}. This value is always between 0 and 1 inclusive.
  16491. @end itemize
  16492. Example programs:
  16493. @itemize
  16494. @item
  16495. Apply dots curtain transition effect:
  16496. @verbatim
  16497. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16498. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16499. __read_only image2d_t src2,
  16500. float progress)
  16501. {
  16502. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16503. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16504. int2 p = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16505. float2 rp = (float2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16506. float2 dim = (float2)(get_image_dim(src1).x, get_image_dim(src1).y);
  16507. rp = rp / dim;
  16508. float2 dots = (float2)(20.0, 20.0);
  16509. float2 center = (float2)(0,0);
  16510. float2 unused;
  16511. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, p);
  16512. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, p);
  16513. bool next = distance(fract(rp * dots, &unused), (float2)(0.5, 0.5)) < (progress / distance(rp, center));
  16514. write_imagef(dst, p, next ? val1 : val2);
  16515. }
  16516. @end verbatim
  16517. @end itemize
  16518. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16519. @chapter VAAPI Video Filters
  16520. @c man begin VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16521. VAAPI Video filters are usually used with VAAPI decoder and VAAPI encoder. Below is a description of VAAPI video filters.
  16522. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16523. @code{--enable-vaapi}.
  16524. To use vaapi filters, you need to setup the vaapi device correctly. For more information, please read @url{https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/VAAPI}
  16525. @section tonemap_vaapi
  16526. Perform HDR(High Dynamic Range) to SDR(Standard Dynamic Range) conversion with tone-mapping.
  16527. It maps the dynamic range of HDR10 content to the SDR content.
  16528. It currently only accepts HDR10 as input.
  16529. It accepts the following parameters:
  16530. @table @option
  16531. @item format
  16532. Specify the output pixel format.
  16533. Currently supported formats are:
  16534. @table @var
  16535. @item p010
  16536. @item nv12
  16537. @end table
  16538. Default is nv12.
  16539. @item primaries, p
  16540. Set the output color primaries.
  16541. Default is same as input.
  16542. @item transfer, t
  16543. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16544. Default is bt709.
  16545. @item matrix, m
  16546. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16547. Default is same as input.
  16548. @end table
  16549. @subsection Example
  16550. @itemize
  16551. @item
  16552. Convert HDR(HDR10) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format
  16553. @example
  16554. tonemap_vaapi=format=p010:t=bt2020-10
  16555. @end example
  16556. @end itemize
  16557. @c man end VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16558. @chapter Video Sources
  16559. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  16560. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  16561. @section buffer
  16562. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  16563. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  16564. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  16565. It accepts the following parameters:
  16566. @table @option
  16567. @item video_size
  16568. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  16569. syntax of this option, check the
  16570. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16571. @item width
  16572. The input video width.
  16573. @item height
  16574. The input video height.
  16575. @item pix_fmt
  16576. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  16577. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  16578. name.
  16579. @item time_base
  16580. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  16581. @item frame_rate
  16582. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  16583. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  16584. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  16585. @item sws_param
  16586. This option is deprecated and ignored. Prepend @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  16587. to the filtergraph description to specify swscale flags for automatically
  16588. inserted scalers. See @ref{Filtergraph syntax}.
  16589. @item hw_frames_ctx
  16590. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  16591. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  16592. @end table
  16593. For example:
  16594. @example
  16595. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  16596. @end example
  16597. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  16598. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  16599. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  16600. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  16601. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  16602. this example corresponds to:
  16603. @example
  16604. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  16605. @end example
  16606. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  16607. syntax is deprecated:
  16608. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}
  16609. @section cellauto
  16610. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  16611. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  16612. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  16613. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  16614. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  16615. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  16616. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  16617. This source accepts the following options:
  16618. @table @option
  16619. @item filename, f
  16620. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16621. the specified file.
  16622. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  16623. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16624. file will be ignored.
  16625. @item pattern, p
  16626. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16627. the specified string.
  16628. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  16629. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16630. string will be ignored.
  16631. @item rate, r
  16632. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16633. Default is 25.
  16634. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16635. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  16636. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  16637. 1/PHI.
  16638. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  16639. @item random_seed, seed
  16640. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  16641. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16642. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16643. effort basis.
  16644. @item rule
  16645. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  16646. Default value is 110.
  16647. @item size, s
  16648. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16649. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16650. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  16651. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  16652. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  16653. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  16654. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  16655. larger row.
  16656. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  16657. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  16658. @item scroll
  16659. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  16660. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  16661. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  16662. Defaults to 1.
  16663. @item start_full, full
  16664. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  16665. outputting the first frame.
  16666. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16667. @item stitch
  16668. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  16669. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16670. @end table
  16671. @subsection Examples
  16672. @itemize
  16673. @item
  16674. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  16675. size 200x400.
  16676. @example
  16677. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  16678. @end example
  16679. @item
  16680. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  16681. ratio of 2/3:
  16682. @example
  16683. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16684. @end example
  16685. @item
  16686. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  16687. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  16688. @example
  16689. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16690. @end example
  16691. @item
  16692. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  16693. @example
  16694. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16695. @end example
  16696. @end itemize
  16697. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  16698. @section coreimagesrc
  16699. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  16700. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  16701. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  16702. generate the content.
  16703. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  16704. @table @option
  16705. @item list_generators
  16706. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  16707. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  16708. @example
  16709. list_generators=true
  16710. @end example
  16711. @item size, s
  16712. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16713. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16714. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16715. @item rate, r
  16716. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16717. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16718. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16719. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16720. "25".
  16721. @item sar
  16722. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16723. @item duration, d
  16724. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16725. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16726. for the accepted syntax.
  16727. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16728. supposed to be generated forever.
  16729. @end table
  16730. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  16731. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  16732. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  16733. and examples for details.
  16734. @subsection Examples
  16735. @itemize
  16736. @item
  16737. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  16738. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  16739. @example
  16740. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  16741. @end example
  16742. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  16743. need for a nullsrc video source.
  16744. @end itemize
  16745. @section mandelbrot
  16746. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  16747. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  16748. This source accepts the following options:
  16749. @table @option
  16750. @item end_pts
  16751. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  16752. @item end_scale
  16753. Set the terminal scale value.
  16754. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  16755. @item inner
  16756. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  16757. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  16758. It shall assume one of the following values:
  16759. @table @option
  16760. @item black
  16761. Set black mode.
  16762. @item convergence
  16763. Show time until convergence.
  16764. @item mincol
  16765. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  16766. @item period
  16767. Set period mode.
  16768. @end table
  16769. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  16770. @item bailout
  16771. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  16772. @item maxiter
  16773. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  16774. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  16775. @item outer
  16776. Set outer coloring mode.
  16777. It shall assume one of following values:
  16778. @table @option
  16779. @item iteration_count
  16780. Set iteration count mode.
  16781. @item normalized_iteration_count
  16782. set normalized iteration count mode.
  16783. @end table
  16784. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  16785. @item rate, r
  16786. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16787. value is "25".
  16788. @item size, s
  16789. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16790. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16791. @item start_scale
  16792. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  16793. @item start_x
  16794. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  16795. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  16796. @item start_y
  16797. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  16798. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  16799. @end table
  16800. @section mptestsrc
  16801. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  16802. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  16803. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  16804. This source accepts the following options:
  16805. @table @option
  16806. @item rate, r
  16807. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16808. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16809. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16810. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16811. "25".
  16812. @item duration, d
  16813. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16814. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16815. for the accepted syntax.
  16816. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16817. supposed to be generated forever.
  16818. @item test, t
  16819. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  16820. @table @option
  16821. @item dc_luma
  16822. @item dc_chroma
  16823. @item freq_luma
  16824. @item freq_chroma
  16825. @item amp_luma
  16826. @item amp_chroma
  16827. @item cbp
  16828. @item mv
  16829. @item ring1
  16830. @item ring2
  16831. @item all
  16832. @item max_frames, m
  16833. Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.
  16834. @end table
  16835. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  16836. @end table
  16837. Some examples:
  16838. @example
  16839. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  16840. @end example
  16841. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  16842. @section frei0r_src
  16843. Provide a frei0r source.
  16844. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  16845. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  16846. This source accepts the following parameters:
  16847. @table @option
  16848. @item size
  16849. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16850. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16851. @item framerate
  16852. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  16853. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  16854. @item filter_name
  16855. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  16856. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  16857. documentation.
  16858. @item filter_params
  16859. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  16860. @end table
  16861. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  16862. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  16863. @example
  16864. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  16865. @end example
  16866. @section life
  16867. Generate a life pattern.
  16868. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  16869. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  16870. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  16871. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  16872. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  16873. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  16874. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  16875. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  16876. the rule to adopt.
  16877. This source accepts the following options:
  16878. @table @option
  16879. @item filename, f
  16880. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  16881. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  16882. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  16883. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  16884. randomly.
  16885. @item rate, r
  16886. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16887. Default is 25.
  16888. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16889. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  16890. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  16891. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  16892. @item random_seed, seed
  16893. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  16894. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16895. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16896. effort basis.
  16897. @item rule
  16898. Set the life rule.
  16899. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  16900. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  16901. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  16902. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  16903. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  16904. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  16905. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  16906. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  16907. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  16908. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  16909. higher number of neighbor cells.
  16910. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  16911. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  16912. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  16913. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  16914. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  16915. a dead cell.
  16916. @item size, s
  16917. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16918. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16919. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  16920. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  16921. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  16922. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  16923. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  16924. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  16925. @item stitch
  16926. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  16927. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  16928. @item mold
  16929. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  16930. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  16931. value from 0 to 255.
  16932. @item life_color
  16933. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  16934. @item death_color
  16935. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  16936. used to represent a dead cell.
  16937. @item mold_color
  16938. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  16939. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  16940. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16941. @end table
  16942. @subsection Examples
  16943. @itemize
  16944. @item
  16945. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  16946. 300x300 pixels:
  16947. @example
  16948. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  16949. @end example
  16950. @item
  16951. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  16952. @example
  16953. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16954. @end example
  16955. @item
  16956. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  16957. @example
  16958. life=rule=S14/B34
  16959. @end example
  16960. @item
  16961. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  16962. @example
  16963. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  16964. @end example
  16965. @end itemize
  16966. @anchor{allrgb}
  16967. @anchor{allyuv}
  16968. @anchor{color}
  16969. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  16970. @anchor{nullsrc}
  16971. @anchor{pal75bars}
  16972. @anchor{pal100bars}
  16973. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  16974. @anchor{smptebars}
  16975. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  16976. @anchor{testsrc}
  16977. @anchor{testsrc2}
  16978. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  16979. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  16980. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  16981. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  16982. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  16983. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  16984. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  16985. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  16986. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  16987. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  16988. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16989. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  16990. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16991. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  16992. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  16993. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  16994. stripe from top to bottom.
  16995. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16996. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  16997. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16998. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  16999. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  17000. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  17001. intended for testing purposes.
  17002. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  17003. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  17004. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  17005. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  17006. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  17007. The sources accept the following parameters:
  17008. @table @option
  17009. @item level
  17010. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  17011. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  17012. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  17013. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  17014. @item color, c
  17015. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  17016. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17017. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17018. @item size, s
  17019. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17020. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17021. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  17022. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  17023. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  17024. @item rate, r
  17025. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17026. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17027. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17028. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17029. "25".
  17030. @item duration, d
  17031. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17032. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17033. for the accepted syntax.
  17034. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17035. supposed to be generated forever.
  17036. @item sar
  17037. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  17038. @item alpha
  17039. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  17040. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  17041. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  17042. @item decimals, n
  17043. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  17044. @code{testsrc} source.
  17045. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  17046. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  17047. value. Default value is 0.
  17048. @end table
  17049. @subsection Examples
  17050. @itemize
  17051. @item
  17052. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  17053. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  17054. @example
  17055. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  17056. @end example
  17057. @item
  17058. The following graph description will generate a red source
  17059. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  17060. frames per second:
  17061. @example
  17062. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  17063. @end example
  17064. @item
  17065. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  17066. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  17067. the @code{geq} filter:
  17068. @example
  17069. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  17070. @end example
  17071. @end itemize
  17072. @subsection Commands
  17073. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  17074. @table @option
  17075. @item c, color
  17076. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  17077. corresponding @option{color} option.
  17078. @end table
  17079. @section openclsrc
  17080. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  17081. @table @option
  17082. @item source
  17083. OpenCL program source file.
  17084. @item kernel
  17085. Kernel name in program.
  17086. @item size, s
  17087. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  17088. @item format
  17089. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  17090. @item rate, r
  17091. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  17092. @end table
  17093. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  17094. filter.
  17095. Example programs:
  17096. @itemize
  17097. @item
  17098. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  17099. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  17100. the generated output will not be the same.)
  17101. @verbatim
  17102. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17103. unsigned int index)
  17104. {
  17105. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17106. float4 val;
  17107. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  17108. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  17109. }
  17110. @end verbatim
  17111. @item
  17112. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  17113. @verbatim
  17114. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17115. unsigned int index)
  17116. {
  17117. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17118. float4 value = 0.0f;
  17119. int x = loc.x + index;
  17120. int y = loc.y + index;
  17121. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  17122. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  17123. value = 1.0f;
  17124. break;
  17125. }
  17126. x /= 3;
  17127. y /= 3;
  17128. }
  17129. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  17130. }
  17131. @end verbatim
  17132. @end itemize
  17133. @section sierpinski
  17134. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  17135. This source accepts the following options:
  17136. @table @option
  17137. @item size, s
  17138. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17139. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17140. @item rate, r
  17141. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17142. value is "25".
  17143. @item seed
  17144. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  17145. @item jump
  17146. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  17147. @item type
  17148. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  17149. @end table
  17150. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  17151. @chapter Video Sinks
  17152. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  17153. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  17154. @section buffersink
  17155. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  17156. graph.
  17157. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  17158. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  17159. or the options system.
  17160. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  17161. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  17162. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  17163. @section nullsink
  17164. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  17165. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  17166. tools.
  17167. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  17168. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  17169. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  17170. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  17171. @section abitscope
  17172. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  17173. The filter accepts the following options:
  17174. @table @option
  17175. @item rate, r
  17176. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17177. value is "25".
  17178. @item size, s
  17179. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17180. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17181. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  17182. @item colors
  17183. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17184. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17185. by white color.
  17186. @end table
  17187. @section adrawgraph
  17188. Draw a graph using input audio metadata.
  17189. See @ref{drawgraph}
  17190. @section agraphmonitor
  17191. See @ref{graphmonitor}.
  17192. @section ahistogram
  17193. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  17194. The filter accepts the following options:
  17195. @table @option
  17196. @item dmode
  17197. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  17198. It accepts the following values:
  17199. @table @samp
  17200. @item single
  17201. Use single histogram for all channels.
  17202. @item separate
  17203. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  17204. @end table
  17205. Default is @code{single}.
  17206. @item rate, r
  17207. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17208. value is "25".
  17209. @item size, s
  17210. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17211. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17212. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  17213. @item scale
  17214. Set display scale.
  17215. It accepts the following values:
  17216. @table @samp
  17217. @item log
  17218. logarithmic
  17219. @item sqrt
  17220. square root
  17221. @item cbrt
  17222. cubic root
  17223. @item lin
  17224. linear
  17225. @item rlog
  17226. reverse logarithmic
  17227. @end table
  17228. Default is @code{log}.
  17229. @item ascale
  17230. Set amplitude scale.
  17231. It accepts the following values:
  17232. @table @samp
  17233. @item log
  17234. logarithmic
  17235. @item lin
  17236. linear
  17237. @end table
  17238. Default is @code{log}.
  17239. @item acount
  17240. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  17241. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  17242. @item rheight
  17243. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  17244. @item slide
  17245. Set sonogram sliding.
  17246. It accepts the following values:
  17247. @table @samp
  17248. @item replace
  17249. replace old rows with new ones.
  17250. @item scroll
  17251. scroll from top to bottom.
  17252. @end table
  17253. Default is @code{replace}.
  17254. @end table
  17255. @section aphasemeter
  17256. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  17257. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  17258. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  17259. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  17260. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  17261. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  17262. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  17263. @table @option
  17264. @item rate, r
  17265. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17266. @item size, s
  17267. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17268. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17269. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  17270. @item rc
  17271. @item gc
  17272. @item bc
  17273. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  17274. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  17275. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17276. @item mpc
  17277. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  17278. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  17279. @item video
  17280. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  17281. @end table
  17282. @section avectorscope
  17283. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  17284. scope.
  17285. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  17286. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  17287. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  17288. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  17289. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  17290. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  17291. The filter accepts the following options:
  17292. @table @option
  17293. @item mode, m
  17294. Set the vectorscope mode.
  17295. Available values are:
  17296. @table @samp
  17297. @item lissajous
  17298. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  17299. @item lissajous_xy
  17300. Same as above but not rotated.
  17301. @item polar
  17302. Shape resembling half of circle.
  17303. @end table
  17304. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  17305. @item size, s
  17306. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17307. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17308. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  17309. @item rate, r
  17310. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17311. @item rc
  17312. @item gc
  17313. @item bc
  17314. @item ac
  17315. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  17316. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  17317. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17318. @item rf
  17319. @item gf
  17320. @item bf
  17321. @item af
  17322. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  17323. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  17324. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17325. @item zoom
  17326. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17327. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  17328. @item draw
  17329. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  17330. Available values are:
  17331. @table @samp
  17332. @item dot
  17333. Draw dot for each sample.
  17334. @item line
  17335. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  17336. @end table
  17337. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  17338. @item scale
  17339. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  17340. Available values are:
  17341. @table @samp
  17342. @item lin
  17343. Linear.
  17344. @item sqrt
  17345. Square root.
  17346. @item cbrt
  17347. Cubic root.
  17348. @item log
  17349. Logarithmic.
  17350. @end table
  17351. @item swap
  17352. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  17353. @item mirror
  17354. Mirror axis.
  17355. @table @samp
  17356. @item none
  17357. No mirror.
  17358. @item x
  17359. Mirror only x axis.
  17360. @item y
  17361. Mirror only y axis.
  17362. @item xy
  17363. Mirror both axis.
  17364. @end table
  17365. @end table
  17366. @subsection Examples
  17367. @itemize
  17368. @item
  17369. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  17370. @example
  17371. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17372. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  17373. @end example
  17374. @end itemize
  17375. @section bench, abench
  17376. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  17377. The filter accepts the following options:
  17378. @table @option
  17379. @item action
  17380. Start or stop a timer.
  17381. Available values are:
  17382. @table @samp
  17383. @item start
  17384. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  17385. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  17386. @item stop
  17387. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  17388. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  17389. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  17390. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  17391. @end table
  17392. @end table
  17393. @subsection Examples
  17394. @itemize
  17395. @item
  17396. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  17397. @example
  17398. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  17399. @end example
  17400. @end itemize
  17401. @section concat
  17402. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  17403. other.
  17404. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  17405. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  17406. also be the number of streams at output.
  17407. The filter accepts the following options:
  17408. @table @option
  17409. @item n
  17410. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  17411. @item v
  17412. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  17413. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  17414. @item a
  17415. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  17416. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  17417. @item unsafe
  17418. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  17419. @end table
  17420. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  17421. @var{a} audio outputs.
  17422. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  17423. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  17424. segment, etc.
  17425. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  17426. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  17427. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  17428. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  17429. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  17430. audio streams with silence.
  17431. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  17432. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  17433. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  17434. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  17435. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  17436. explicitly by the user.
  17437. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  17438. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  17439. @subsection Examples
  17440. @itemize
  17441. @item
  17442. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  17443. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  17444. @example
  17445. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  17446. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  17447. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  17448. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  17449. @end example
  17450. @item
  17451. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  17452. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  17453. @example
  17454. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  17455. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  17456. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  17457. @end example
  17458. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  17459. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  17460. @end itemize
  17461. @subsection Commands
  17462. This filter supports the following commands:
  17463. @table @option
  17464. @item next
  17465. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  17466. @end table
  17467. @anchor{ebur128}
  17468. @section ebur128
  17469. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  17470. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  17471. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  17472. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  17473. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  17474. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  17475. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  17476. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  17477. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  17478. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  17479. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  17480. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  17481. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  17482. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  17483. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  17484. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  17485. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  17486. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  17487. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  17488. The filter accepts the following options:
  17489. @table @option
  17490. @item video
  17491. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  17492. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  17493. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  17494. @item size
  17495. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  17496. option, check the
  17497. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17498. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  17499. @item meter
  17500. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  17501. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  17502. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  17503. @item metadata
  17504. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  17505. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  17506. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  17507. Default is @code{0}.
  17508. @item framelog
  17509. Force the frame logging level.
  17510. Available values are:
  17511. @table @samp
  17512. @item info
  17513. information logging level
  17514. @item verbose
  17515. verbose logging level
  17516. @end table
  17517. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  17518. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  17519. @item peak
  17520. Set peak mode(s).
  17521. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  17522. values are:
  17523. @table @samp
  17524. @item none
  17525. Disable any peak mode (default).
  17526. @item sample
  17527. Enable sample-peak mode.
  17528. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  17529. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  17530. @item true
  17531. Enable true-peak mode.
  17532. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  17533. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  17534. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  17535. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  17536. @end table
  17537. @item dualmono
  17538. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  17539. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  17540. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  17541. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  17542. @item panlaw
  17543. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  17544. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  17545. @item target
  17546. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  17547. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  17548. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  17549. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  17550. @item gauge
  17551. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  17552. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  17553. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  17554. live mixing).
  17555. @item scale
  17556. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  17557. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  17558. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  17559. @end table
  17560. @subsection Examples
  17561. @itemize
  17562. @item
  17563. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  17564. @example
  17565. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  17566. @end example
  17567. @item
  17568. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  17569. @example
  17570. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  17571. @end example
  17572. @end itemize
  17573. @section interleave, ainterleave
  17574. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  17575. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  17576. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  17577. queued frame to the output.
  17578. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  17579. timestamp values.
  17580. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  17581. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  17582. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  17583. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  17584. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  17585. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  17586. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  17587. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  17588. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  17589. the queue is already filled.
  17590. These filters accept the following options:
  17591. @table @option
  17592. @item nb_inputs, n
  17593. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  17594. @end table
  17595. @subsection Examples
  17596. @itemize
  17597. @item
  17598. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17599. @example
  17600. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  17601. @end example
  17602. @item
  17603. Add flickering blur effect:
  17604. @example
  17605. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  17606. @end example
  17607. @end itemize
  17608. @section metadata, ametadata
  17609. Manipulate frame metadata.
  17610. This filter accepts the following options:
  17611. @table @option
  17612. @item mode
  17613. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  17614. Can be one of the following:
  17615. @table @samp
  17616. @item select
  17617. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  17618. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  17619. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  17620. @item add
  17621. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  17622. do nothing.
  17623. @item modify
  17624. Modify value of already present key.
  17625. @item delete
  17626. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  17627. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  17628. the frame.
  17629. @item print
  17630. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  17631. metadata values available in frame.
  17632. @end table
  17633. @item key
  17634. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  17635. @item value
  17636. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  17637. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  17638. @item function
  17639. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  17640. Can be one of following:
  17641. @table @samp
  17642. @item same_str
  17643. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  17644. @item starts_with
  17645. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  17646. the @code{value} option string.
  17647. @item less
  17648. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  17649. @item equal
  17650. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  17651. @item greater
  17652. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  17653. @item expr
  17654. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  17655. evaluates to true.
  17656. @item ends_with
  17657. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  17658. the @code{value} option string.
  17659. @end table
  17660. @item expr
  17661. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  17662. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17663. constants:
  17664. @table @option
  17665. @item VALUE1
  17666. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  17667. @item VALUE2
  17668. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  17669. @end table
  17670. @item file
  17671. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  17672. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  17673. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  17674. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  17675. @item direct
  17676. Reduces buffering in print mode when output is written to a URL set using @var{file}.
  17677. @end table
  17678. @subsection Examples
  17679. @itemize
  17680. @item
  17681. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  17682. between 0 and 1.
  17683. @example
  17684. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  17685. @end example
  17686. @item
  17687. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  17688. @example
  17689. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  17690. @end example
  17691. @item
  17692. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  17693. @example
  17694. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  17695. @end example
  17696. @end itemize
  17697. @section perms, aperms
  17698. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  17699. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  17700. following filter in the filtergraph.
  17701. The filters accept the following options:
  17702. @table @option
  17703. @item mode
  17704. Select the permissions mode.
  17705. It accepts the following values:
  17706. @table @samp
  17707. @item none
  17708. Do nothing. This is the default.
  17709. @item ro
  17710. Set all the output frames read-only.
  17711. @item rw
  17712. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  17713. @item toggle
  17714. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  17715. @item random
  17716. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  17717. @end table
  17718. @item seed
  17719. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  17720. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  17721. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  17722. basis.
  17723. @end table
  17724. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  17725. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  17726. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  17727. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  17728. @section realtime, arealtime
  17729. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  17730. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  17731. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  17732. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  17733. They accept the following options:
  17734. @table @option
  17735. @item limit
  17736. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  17737. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  17738. @item speed
  17739. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  17740. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  17741. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  17742. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  17743. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  17744. be achieved.
  17745. @end table
  17746. @anchor{select}
  17747. @section select, aselect
  17748. Select frames to pass in output.
  17749. This filter accepts the following options:
  17750. @table @option
  17751. @item expr, e
  17752. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  17753. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  17754. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  17755. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  17756. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  17757. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  17758. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  17759. @item outputs, n
  17760. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  17761. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  17762. @end table
  17763. The expression can contain the following constants:
  17764. @table @option
  17765. @item n
  17766. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  17767. @item selected_n
  17768. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  17769. @item prev_selected_n
  17770. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17771. @item TB
  17772. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17773. @item pts
  17774. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  17775. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  17776. @item t
  17777. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  17778. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17779. @item prev_pts
  17780. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17781. @item prev_selected_pts
  17782. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17783. @item prev_selected_t
  17784. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17785. @item start_pts
  17786. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17787. @item start_t
  17788. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17789. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  17790. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  17791. values:
  17792. @table @option
  17793. @item I
  17794. @item P
  17795. @item B
  17796. @item S
  17797. @item SI
  17798. @item SP
  17799. @item BI
  17800. @end table
  17801. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  17802. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  17803. @table @option
  17804. @item PROGRESSIVE
  17805. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  17806. @item TOPFIRST
  17807. The frame is top-field-first.
  17808. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  17809. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  17810. @end table
  17811. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17812. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  17813. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17814. the number of samples in the current frame
  17815. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  17816. the input sample rate
  17817. @item key
  17818. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  17819. @item pos
  17820. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  17821. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  17822. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  17823. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  17824. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  17825. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  17826. @item concatdec_select
  17827. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  17828. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  17829. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  17830. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  17831. interval.
  17832. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  17833. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  17834. present in the decoded frames.
  17835. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  17836. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  17837. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  17838. missing.
  17839. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  17840. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  17841. @end table
  17842. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  17843. @subsection Examples
  17844. @itemize
  17845. @item
  17846. Select all frames in input:
  17847. @example
  17848. select
  17849. @end example
  17850. The example above is the same as:
  17851. @example
  17852. select=1
  17853. @end example
  17854. @item
  17855. Skip all frames:
  17856. @example
  17857. select=0
  17858. @end example
  17859. @item
  17860. Select only I-frames:
  17861. @example
  17862. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  17863. @end example
  17864. @item
  17865. Select one frame every 100:
  17866. @example
  17867. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  17868. @end example
  17869. @item
  17870. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17871. @example
  17872. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  17873. @end example
  17874. @item
  17875. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17876. @example
  17877. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  17878. @end example
  17879. @item
  17880. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  17881. @example
  17882. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  17883. @end example
  17884. @item
  17885. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  17886. @example
  17887. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  17888. @end example
  17889. @item
  17890. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  17891. @example
  17892. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  17893. @end example
  17894. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  17895. choice.
  17896. @item
  17897. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  17898. @example
  17899. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  17900. @end example
  17901. @item
  17902. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  17903. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  17904. @example
  17905. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  17906. @end example
  17907. @end itemize
  17908. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  17909. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  17910. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  17911. filtergraph.
  17912. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  17913. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  17914. from that they act the same way.
  17915. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  17916. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  17917. @var{filename} option.
  17918. These filters accept the following options:
  17919. @table @option
  17920. @item commands, c
  17921. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  17922. @item filename, f
  17923. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  17924. filters.
  17925. @end table
  17926. @subsection Commands syntax
  17927. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  17928. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  17929. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  17930. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  17931. interval.
  17932. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  17933. @example
  17934. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  17935. @end example
  17936. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  17937. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  17938. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  17939. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  17940. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  17941. @var{END}.
  17942. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  17943. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  17944. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  17945. @example
  17946. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  17947. @end example
  17948. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  17949. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  17950. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  17951. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  17952. The following flags are recognized:
  17953. @table @option
  17954. @item enter
  17955. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  17956. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17957. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  17958. current is.
  17959. @item leave
  17960. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  17961. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17962. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  17963. current is not.
  17964. @end table
  17965. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  17966. assumed.
  17967. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  17968. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  17969. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  17970. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  17971. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  17972. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  17973. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  17974. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  17975. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  17976. follows:
  17977. @example
  17978. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  17979. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  17980. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  17981. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  17982. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  17983. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  17984. @end example
  17985. @subsection Examples
  17986. @itemize
  17987. @item
  17988. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  17989. @example
  17990. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  17991. @end example
  17992. @item
  17993. Target a specific filter instance:
  17994. @example
  17995. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  17996. @end example
  17997. @item
  17998. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  17999. @example
  18000. # show text in the interval 5-10
  18001. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  18002. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  18003. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  18004. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  18005. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  18006. [leave] hue s 1,
  18007. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  18008. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  18009. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  18010. @end example
  18011. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  18012. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  18013. @example
  18014. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  18015. @end example
  18016. @end itemize
  18017. @anchor{setpts}
  18018. @section setpts, asetpts
  18019. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  18020. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  18021. This filter accepts the following options:
  18022. @table @option
  18023. @item expr
  18024. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  18025. @end table
  18026. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18027. constants:
  18028. @table @option
  18029. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  18030. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  18031. @item PTS
  18032. The presentation timestamp in input
  18033. @item N
  18034. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  18035. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  18036. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  18037. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  18038. audio)
  18039. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  18040. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  18041. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  18042. The audio sample rate.
  18043. @item STARTPTS
  18044. The PTS of the first frame.
  18045. @item STARTT
  18046. the time in seconds of the first frame
  18047. @item INTERLACED
  18048. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  18049. @item T
  18050. the time in seconds of the current frame
  18051. @item POS
  18052. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18053. for the current frame
  18054. @item PREV_INPTS
  18055. The previous input PTS.
  18056. @item PREV_INT
  18057. previous input time in seconds
  18058. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  18059. The previous output PTS.
  18060. @item PREV_OUTT
  18061. previous output time in seconds
  18062. @item RTCTIME
  18063. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  18064. instead.
  18065. @item RTCSTART
  18066. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  18067. @item TB
  18068. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  18069. @end table
  18070. @subsection Examples
  18071. @itemize
  18072. @item
  18073. Start counting PTS from zero
  18074. @example
  18075. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  18076. @end example
  18077. @item
  18078. Apply fast motion effect:
  18079. @example
  18080. setpts=0.5*PTS
  18081. @end example
  18082. @item
  18083. Apply slow motion effect:
  18084. @example
  18085. setpts=2.0*PTS
  18086. @end example
  18087. @item
  18088. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  18089. @example
  18090. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  18091. @end example
  18092. @item
  18093. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  18094. @example
  18095. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  18096. @end example
  18097. @item
  18098. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  18099. @example
  18100. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  18101. @end example
  18102. @item
  18103. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  18104. @example
  18105. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  18106. @end example
  18107. @item
  18108. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  18109. @example
  18110. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  18111. @end example
  18112. @end itemize
  18113. @section setrange
  18114. Force color range for the output video frame.
  18115. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  18116. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  18117. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  18118. following filters.
  18119. The filter accepts the following options:
  18120. @table @option
  18121. @item range
  18122. Available values are:
  18123. @table @samp
  18124. @item auto
  18125. Keep the same color range property.
  18126. @item unspecified, unknown
  18127. Set the color range as unspecified.
  18128. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  18129. Set the color range as limited.
  18130. @item full, pc, jpeg
  18131. Set the color range as full.
  18132. @end table
  18133. @end table
  18134. @section settb, asettb
  18135. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  18136. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  18137. It accepts the following parameters:
  18138. @table @option
  18139. @item expr, tb
  18140. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  18141. @end table
  18142. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  18143. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  18144. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  18145. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  18146. @subsection Examples
  18147. @itemize
  18148. @item
  18149. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  18150. @example
  18151. settb=expr=1/25
  18152. @end example
  18153. @item
  18154. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  18155. @example
  18156. settb=expr=0.1
  18157. @end example
  18158. @item
  18159. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  18160. @example
  18161. settb=1+0.001
  18162. @end example
  18163. @item
  18164. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  18165. @example
  18166. settb=2*intb
  18167. @end example
  18168. @item
  18169. Set the default timebase value:
  18170. @example
  18171. settb=AVTB
  18172. @end example
  18173. @end itemize
  18174. @section showcqt
  18175. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  18176. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  18177. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  18178. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  18179. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  18180. The filter accepts the following options:
  18181. @table @option
  18182. @item size, s
  18183. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  18184. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18185. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  18186. @item fps, rate, r
  18187. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  18188. @item bar_h
  18189. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18190. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  18191. @item axis_h
  18192. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  18193. the axis height automatically.
  18194. @item sono_h
  18195. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18196. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  18197. @item fullhd
  18198. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  18199. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  18200. @item sono_v, volume
  18201. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18202. @table @option
  18203. @item bar_v
  18204. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  18205. @item frequency, freq, f
  18206. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18207. @item timeclamp, tc
  18208. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18209. @end table
  18210. and functions:
  18211. @table @option
  18212. @item a_weighting(f)
  18213. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18214. @item b_weighting(f)
  18215. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18216. @item c_weighting(f)
  18217. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18218. @end table
  18219. Default value is @code{16}.
  18220. @item bar_v, volume2
  18221. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18222. @table @option
  18223. @item sono_v
  18224. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  18225. @item frequency, freq, f
  18226. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18227. @item timeclamp, tc
  18228. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18229. @end table
  18230. and functions:
  18231. @table @option
  18232. @item a_weighting(f)
  18233. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18234. @item b_weighting(f)
  18235. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18236. @item c_weighting(f)
  18237. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18238. @end table
  18239. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  18240. @item sono_g, gamma
  18241. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  18242. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  18243. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  18244. @item bar_g, gamma2
  18245. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  18246. @code{[1, 7]}.
  18247. @item bar_t
  18248. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  18249. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18250. @item timeclamp, tc
  18251. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  18252. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  18253. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  18254. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  18255. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  18256. @item attack
  18257. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  18258. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  18259. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18260. @item basefreq
  18261. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  18262. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18263. @item endfreq
  18264. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  18265. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18266. @item coeffclamp
  18267. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  18268. @item tlength
  18269. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  18270. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  18271. It can contain variables:
  18272. @table @option
  18273. @item frequency, freq, f
  18274. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18275. @item timeclamp, tc
  18276. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  18277. @end table
  18278. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  18279. @item count
  18280. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  18281. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  18282. @item fcount
  18283. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  18284. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  18285. @item fontfile
  18286. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  18287. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  18288. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  18289. option instead.
  18290. @item font
  18291. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  18292. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  18293. escaping.
  18294. @item fontcolor
  18295. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  18296. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  18297. @table @option
  18298. @item frequency, freq, f
  18299. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18300. @item timeclamp, tc
  18301. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18302. @end table
  18303. and functions:
  18304. @table @option
  18305. @item midi(f)
  18306. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  18307. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  18308. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  18309. @end table
  18310. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  18311. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  18312. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  18313. @item axisfile
  18314. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  18315. @var{fontcolor} option.
  18316. @item axis, text
  18317. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  18318. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  18319. Default value is @code{1}.
  18320. @item csp
  18321. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  18322. @table @samp
  18323. @item unspecified
  18324. Unspecified (default)
  18325. @item bt709
  18326. BT.709
  18327. @item fcc
  18328. FCC
  18329. @item bt470bg
  18330. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  18331. @item smpte170m
  18332. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  18333. @item smpte240m
  18334. SMPTE-240M
  18335. @item bt2020ncl
  18336. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  18337. @end table
  18338. @item cscheme
  18339. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  18340. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  18341. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  18342. @end table
  18343. @subsection Examples
  18344. @itemize
  18345. @item
  18346. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  18347. @example
  18348. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18349. @end example
  18350. @item
  18351. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  18352. @example
  18353. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  18354. @end example
  18355. @item
  18356. Playing at 1280x720:
  18357. @example
  18358. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  18359. @end example
  18360. @item
  18361. Disable sonogram display:
  18362. @example
  18363. sono_h=0
  18364. @end example
  18365. @item
  18366. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  18367. @example
  18368. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18369. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18370. @end example
  18371. @item
  18372. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  18373. @example
  18374. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18375. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  18376. @end example
  18377. @item
  18378. Custom volume:
  18379. @example
  18380. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  18381. @end example
  18382. @item
  18383. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  18384. @example
  18385. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  18386. @end example
  18387. @item
  18388. Custom tlength equation:
  18389. @example
  18390. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  18391. @end example
  18392. @item
  18393. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  18394. @example
  18395. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  18396. @end example
  18397. @item
  18398. Custom font using fontconfig:
  18399. @example
  18400. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  18401. @end example
  18402. @item
  18403. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  18404. @example
  18405. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  18406. @end example
  18407. @end itemize
  18408. @section showfreqs
  18409. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  18410. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  18411. The filter accepts the following options:
  18412. @table @option
  18413. @item size, s
  18414. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18415. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18416. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  18417. @item mode
  18418. Set display mode.
  18419. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  18420. It accepts the following values:
  18421. @table @samp
  18422. @item line
  18423. @item bar
  18424. @item dot
  18425. @end table
  18426. Default is @code{bar}.
  18427. @item ascale
  18428. Set amplitude scale.
  18429. It accepts the following values:
  18430. @table @samp
  18431. @item lin
  18432. Linear scale.
  18433. @item sqrt
  18434. Square root scale.
  18435. @item cbrt
  18436. Cubic root scale.
  18437. @item log
  18438. Logarithmic scale.
  18439. @end table
  18440. Default is @code{log}.
  18441. @item fscale
  18442. Set frequency scale.
  18443. It accepts the following values:
  18444. @table @samp
  18445. @item lin
  18446. Linear scale.
  18447. @item log
  18448. Logarithmic scale.
  18449. @item rlog
  18450. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  18451. @end table
  18452. Default is @code{lin}.
  18453. @item win_size
  18454. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  18455. Default is @code{2048}
  18456. @item win_func
  18457. Set windowing function.
  18458. It accepts the following values:
  18459. @table @samp
  18460. @item rect
  18461. @item bartlett
  18462. @item hanning
  18463. @item hamming
  18464. @item blackman
  18465. @item welch
  18466. @item flattop
  18467. @item bharris
  18468. @item bnuttall
  18469. @item bhann
  18470. @item sine
  18471. @item nuttall
  18472. @item lanczos
  18473. @item gauss
  18474. @item tukey
  18475. @item dolph
  18476. @item cauchy
  18477. @item parzen
  18478. @item poisson
  18479. @item bohman
  18480. @end table
  18481. Default is @code{hanning}.
  18482. @item overlap
  18483. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18484. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18485. @item averaging
  18486. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  18487. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  18488. @item colors
  18489. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  18490. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  18491. by white color.
  18492. @item cmode
  18493. Set channel display mode.
  18494. It accepts the following values:
  18495. @table @samp
  18496. @item combined
  18497. @item separate
  18498. @end table
  18499. Default is @code{combined}.
  18500. @item minamp
  18501. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  18502. @end table
  18503. @section showspatial
  18504. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  18505. between two channels.
  18506. The filter accepts the following options:
  18507. @table @option
  18508. @item size, s
  18509. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18510. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18511. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  18512. @item win_size
  18513. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  18514. @item win_func
  18515. Set window function.
  18516. It accepts the following values:
  18517. @table @samp
  18518. @item rect
  18519. @item bartlett
  18520. @item hann
  18521. @item hanning
  18522. @item hamming
  18523. @item blackman
  18524. @item welch
  18525. @item flattop
  18526. @item bharris
  18527. @item bnuttall
  18528. @item bhann
  18529. @item sine
  18530. @item nuttall
  18531. @item lanczos
  18532. @item gauss
  18533. @item tukey
  18534. @item dolph
  18535. @item cauchy
  18536. @item parzen
  18537. @item poisson
  18538. @item bohman
  18539. @end table
  18540. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18541. @item overlap
  18542. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  18543. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18544. window function currently used.
  18545. @end table
  18546. @anchor{showspectrum}
  18547. @section showspectrum
  18548. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  18549. spectrum.
  18550. The filter accepts the following options:
  18551. @table @option
  18552. @item size, s
  18553. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18554. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18555. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  18556. @item slide
  18557. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  18558. It accepts the following values:
  18559. @table @samp
  18560. @item replace
  18561. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  18562. @item scroll
  18563. the samples scroll from right to left
  18564. @item fullframe
  18565. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  18566. @item rscroll
  18567. the samples scroll from left to right
  18568. @end table
  18569. Default value is @code{replace}.
  18570. @item mode
  18571. Specify display mode.
  18572. It accepts the following values:
  18573. @table @samp
  18574. @item combined
  18575. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18576. @item separate
  18577. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18578. @end table
  18579. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18580. @item color
  18581. Specify display color mode.
  18582. It accepts the following values:
  18583. @table @samp
  18584. @item channel
  18585. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18586. @item intensity
  18587. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18588. @item rainbow
  18589. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18590. @item moreland
  18591. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18592. @item nebulae
  18593. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18594. @item fire
  18595. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18596. @item fiery
  18597. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18598. @item fruit
  18599. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18600. @item cool
  18601. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18602. @item magma
  18603. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18604. @item green
  18605. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18606. @item viridis
  18607. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18608. @item plasma
  18609. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18610. @item cividis
  18611. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18612. @item terrain
  18613. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18614. @end table
  18615. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  18616. @item scale
  18617. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18618. It accepts the following values:
  18619. @table @samp
  18620. @item lin
  18621. linear
  18622. @item sqrt
  18623. square root, default
  18624. @item cbrt
  18625. cubic root
  18626. @item log
  18627. logarithmic
  18628. @item 4thrt
  18629. 4th root
  18630. @item 5thrt
  18631. 5th root
  18632. @end table
  18633. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  18634. @item fscale
  18635. Specify frequency scale.
  18636. It accepts the following values:
  18637. @table @samp
  18638. @item lin
  18639. linear
  18640. @item log
  18641. logarithmic
  18642. @end table
  18643. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18644. @item saturation
  18645. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18646. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18647. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18648. Default value is @code{1}.
  18649. @item win_func
  18650. Set window function.
  18651. It accepts the following values:
  18652. @table @samp
  18653. @item rect
  18654. @item bartlett
  18655. @item hann
  18656. @item hanning
  18657. @item hamming
  18658. @item blackman
  18659. @item welch
  18660. @item flattop
  18661. @item bharris
  18662. @item bnuttall
  18663. @item bhann
  18664. @item sine
  18665. @item nuttall
  18666. @item lanczos
  18667. @item gauss
  18668. @item tukey
  18669. @item dolph
  18670. @item cauchy
  18671. @item parzen
  18672. @item poisson
  18673. @item bohman
  18674. @end table
  18675. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18676. @item orientation
  18677. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18678. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18679. @item overlap
  18680. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  18681. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18682. window function currently used.
  18683. @item gain
  18684. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18685. Default value is @code{1}.
  18686. @item data
  18687. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  18688. @item rotation
  18689. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18690. Default value is @code{0}.
  18691. @item start
  18692. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18693. @item stop
  18694. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18695. @item fps
  18696. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  18697. @item legend
  18698. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  18699. @end table
  18700. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  18701. section.
  18702. @subsection Examples
  18703. @itemize
  18704. @item
  18705. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  18706. @example
  18707. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  18708. @end example
  18709. @item
  18710. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  18711. @example
  18712. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  18713. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  18714. @end example
  18715. @end itemize
  18716. @section showspectrumpic
  18717. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  18718. spectrum.
  18719. The filter accepts the following options:
  18720. @table @option
  18721. @item size, s
  18722. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18723. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18724. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  18725. @item mode
  18726. Specify display mode.
  18727. It accepts the following values:
  18728. @table @samp
  18729. @item combined
  18730. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18731. @item separate
  18732. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18733. @end table
  18734. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18735. @item color
  18736. Specify display color mode.
  18737. It accepts the following values:
  18738. @table @samp
  18739. @item channel
  18740. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18741. @item intensity
  18742. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18743. @item rainbow
  18744. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18745. @item moreland
  18746. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18747. @item nebulae
  18748. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18749. @item fire
  18750. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18751. @item fiery
  18752. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18753. @item fruit
  18754. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18755. @item cool
  18756. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18757. @item magma
  18758. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18759. @item green
  18760. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18761. @item viridis
  18762. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18763. @item plasma
  18764. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18765. @item cividis
  18766. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18767. @item terrain
  18768. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18769. @end table
  18770. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  18771. @item scale
  18772. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18773. It accepts the following values:
  18774. @table @samp
  18775. @item lin
  18776. linear
  18777. @item sqrt
  18778. square root, default
  18779. @item cbrt
  18780. cubic root
  18781. @item log
  18782. logarithmic
  18783. @item 4thrt
  18784. 4th root
  18785. @item 5thrt
  18786. 5th root
  18787. @end table
  18788. Default value is @samp{log}.
  18789. @item fscale
  18790. Specify frequency scale.
  18791. It accepts the following values:
  18792. @table @samp
  18793. @item lin
  18794. linear
  18795. @item log
  18796. logarithmic
  18797. @end table
  18798. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18799. @item saturation
  18800. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18801. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18802. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18803. Default value is @code{1}.
  18804. @item win_func
  18805. Set window function.
  18806. It accepts the following values:
  18807. @table @samp
  18808. @item rect
  18809. @item bartlett
  18810. @item hann
  18811. @item hanning
  18812. @item hamming
  18813. @item blackman
  18814. @item welch
  18815. @item flattop
  18816. @item bharris
  18817. @item bnuttall
  18818. @item bhann
  18819. @item sine
  18820. @item nuttall
  18821. @item lanczos
  18822. @item gauss
  18823. @item tukey
  18824. @item dolph
  18825. @item cauchy
  18826. @item parzen
  18827. @item poisson
  18828. @item bohman
  18829. @end table
  18830. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18831. @item orientation
  18832. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18833. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18834. @item gain
  18835. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18836. Default value is @code{1}.
  18837. @item legend
  18838. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  18839. @item rotation
  18840. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18841. Default value is @code{0}.
  18842. @item start
  18843. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18844. @item stop
  18845. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18846. @end table
  18847. @subsection Examples
  18848. @itemize
  18849. @item
  18850. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  18851. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18852. @example
  18853. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  18854. @end example
  18855. @end itemize
  18856. @section showvolume
  18857. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  18858. The filter accepts the following options:
  18859. @table @option
  18860. @item rate, r
  18861. Set video rate.
  18862. @item b
  18863. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  18864. @item w
  18865. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  18866. @item h
  18867. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  18868. @item f
  18869. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  18870. @item c
  18871. Set volume color expression.
  18872. The expression can use the following variables:
  18873. @table @option
  18874. @item VOLUME
  18875. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  18876. @item PEAK
  18877. Current peak.
  18878. @item CHANNEL
  18879. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  18880. @end table
  18881. @item t
  18882. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  18883. @item v
  18884. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  18885. @item o
  18886. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  18887. default is @code{h}.
  18888. @item s
  18889. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  18890. step is disabled.
  18891. @item p
  18892. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  18893. @item m
  18894. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  18895. default is @code{p}.
  18896. @item ds
  18897. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  18898. default is @code{lin}.
  18899. @item dm
  18900. In second.
  18901. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  18902. in the previous seconds.
  18903. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  18904. @item dmc
  18905. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  18906. default is: @code{orange}
  18907. @end table
  18908. @section showwaves
  18909. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  18910. The filter accepts the following options:
  18911. @table @option
  18912. @item size, s
  18913. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18914. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18915. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18916. @item mode
  18917. Set display mode.
  18918. Available values are:
  18919. @table @samp
  18920. @item point
  18921. Draw a point for each sample.
  18922. @item line
  18923. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  18924. @item p2p
  18925. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  18926. @item cline
  18927. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  18928. @end table
  18929. Default value is @code{point}.
  18930. @item n
  18931. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  18932. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  18933. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  18934. is not explicitly specified.
  18935. @item rate, r
  18936. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  18937. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  18938. @item split_channels
  18939. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18940. @item colors
  18941. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18942. @item scale
  18943. Set amplitude scale.
  18944. Available values are:
  18945. @table @samp
  18946. @item lin
  18947. Linear.
  18948. @item log
  18949. Logarithmic.
  18950. @item sqrt
  18951. Square root.
  18952. @item cbrt
  18953. Cubic root.
  18954. @end table
  18955. Default is linear.
  18956. @item draw
  18957. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  18958. Available values are:
  18959. @table @samp
  18960. @item scale
  18961. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18962. @item full
  18963. Draw every sample directly.
  18964. @end table
  18965. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18966. @end table
  18967. @subsection Examples
  18968. @itemize
  18969. @item
  18970. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  18971. at the same time:
  18972. @example
  18973. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  18974. @end example
  18975. @item
  18976. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  18977. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  18978. @example
  18979. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  18980. @end example
  18981. @end itemize
  18982. @section showwavespic
  18983. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  18984. The filter accepts the following options:
  18985. @table @option
  18986. @item size, s
  18987. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18988. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18989. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18990. @item split_channels
  18991. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18992. @item colors
  18993. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18994. @item scale
  18995. Set amplitude scale.
  18996. Available values are:
  18997. @table @samp
  18998. @item lin
  18999. Linear.
  19000. @item log
  19001. Logarithmic.
  19002. @item sqrt
  19003. Square root.
  19004. @item cbrt
  19005. Cubic root.
  19006. @end table
  19007. Default is linear.
  19008. @item draw
  19009. Set the draw mode.
  19010. Available values are:
  19011. @table @samp
  19012. @item scale
  19013. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19014. @item full
  19015. Draw every sample directly.
  19016. @end table
  19017. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19018. @end table
  19019. @subsection Examples
  19020. @itemize
  19021. @item
  19022. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  19023. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  19024. @example
  19025. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  19026. @end example
  19027. @end itemize
  19028. @section sidedata, asidedata
  19029. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  19030. This filter accepts the following options:
  19031. @table @option
  19032. @item mode
  19033. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  19034. Can be one of the following:
  19035. @table @samp
  19036. @item select
  19037. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  19038. @item delete
  19039. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  19040. data in the frame.
  19041. @end table
  19042. @item type
  19043. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  19044. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  19045. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  19046. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  19047. @end table
  19048. @section spectrumsynth
  19049. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  19050. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  19051. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  19052. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  19053. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  19054. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  19055. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  19056. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  19057. it's just recreated from random noise.
  19058. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  19059. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  19060. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  19061. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  19062. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  19063. The filter accepts the following options:
  19064. @table @option
  19065. @item sample_rate
  19066. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  19067. spectrum was generated may differ.
  19068. @item channels
  19069. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  19070. @item scale
  19071. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  19072. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  19073. @item slide
  19074. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  19075. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  19076. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  19077. @item win_func
  19078. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  19079. @item overlap
  19080. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  19081. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  19082. @item orientation
  19083. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  19084. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19085. @end table
  19086. @subsection Examples
  19087. @itemize
  19088. @item
  19089. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  19090. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  19091. @example
  19092. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  19093. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  19094. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  19095. @end example
  19096. @end itemize
  19097. @section split, asplit
  19098. Split input into several identical outputs.
  19099. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  19100. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  19101. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  19102. @subsection Examples
  19103. @itemize
  19104. @item
  19105. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  19106. @example
  19107. [in] split [out0][out1]
  19108. @end example
  19109. @item
  19110. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  19111. outputs, like in:
  19112. @example
  19113. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  19114. @end example
  19115. @item
  19116. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  19117. one padded:
  19118. @example
  19119. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  19120. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  19121. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  19122. @end example
  19123. @item
  19124. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  19125. @example
  19126. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  19127. @end example
  19128. @end itemize
  19129. @section zmq, azmq
  19130. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  19131. filters in the filtergraph.
  19132. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  19133. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  19134. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  19135. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  19136. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  19137. For more information about libzmq see:
  19138. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  19139. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  19140. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  19141. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  19142. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  19143. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  19144. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  19145. The received message must be in the form:
  19146. @example
  19147. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  19148. @end example
  19149. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  19150. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  19151. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  19152. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  19153. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  19154. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  19155. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  19156. given @var{COMMAND}.
  19157. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  19158. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  19159. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  19160. @example
  19161. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  19162. @var{MESSAGE}
  19163. @end example
  19164. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  19165. @subsection Examples
  19166. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  19167. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  19168. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  19169. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  19170. filters will have default instance names.
  19171. @example
  19172. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  19173. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  19174. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  19175. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  19176. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  19177. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  19178. @end example
  19179. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  19180. command can be used:
  19181. @example
  19182. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  19183. @end example
  19184. To change the right side:
  19185. @example
  19186. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  19187. @end example
  19188. To change the position of the right side:
  19189. @example
  19190. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  19191. @end example
  19192. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  19193. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  19194. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  19195. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  19196. @section amovie
  19197. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  19198. stream by default.
  19199. @anchor{movie}
  19200. @section movie
  19201. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  19202. It accepts the following parameters:
  19203. @table @option
  19204. @item filename
  19205. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  19206. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  19207. @item format_name, f
  19208. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  19209. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  19210. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  19211. @item seek_point, sp
  19212. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  19213. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  19214. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  19215. postfix. The default value is "0".
  19216. @item streams, s
  19217. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  19218. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  19219. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  19220. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  19221. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  19222. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  19223. @item stream_index, si
  19224. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  19225. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  19226. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  19227. audio instead of video.
  19228. @item loop
  19229. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  19230. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  19231. Default value is "1".
  19232. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  19233. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  19234. @item discontinuity
  19235. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  19236. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  19237. timestamps.
  19238. @end table
  19239. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  19240. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  19241. @example
  19242. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  19243. ^
  19244. |
  19245. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  19246. @end example
  19247. @subsection Examples
  19248. @itemize
  19249. @item
  19250. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  19251. on top of the input labelled "in":
  19252. @example
  19253. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19254. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19255. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19256. @end example
  19257. @item
  19258. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  19259. labelled "in":
  19260. @example
  19261. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19262. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19263. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19264. @end example
  19265. @item
  19266. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  19267. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  19268. connected to the pad named "audio":
  19269. @example
  19270. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  19271. @end example
  19272. @end itemize
  19273. @subsection Commands
  19274. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  19275. @table @option
  19276. @item seek
  19277. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  19278. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  19279. @itemize
  19280. @item
  19281. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  19282. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  19283. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  19284. @item
  19285. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  19286. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19287. @item
  19288. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  19289. @end itemize
  19290. @item get_duration
  19291. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19292. @end table
  19293. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES